blob: bd2de33f4ba1674987da8999e40e6dd63c1bde97 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100489 - tune.maxaccept
490 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200491 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200492 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100493 - tune.rcvbuf.client
494 - tune.rcvbuf.server
495 - tune.sndbuf.client
496 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100497 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100498 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200499 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100500 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200501 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100502 - tune.zlib.memlevel
503 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 * Debugging
506 - debug
507 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508
509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511------------------------------------
512
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513ca-base <dir>
514 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200515 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
516 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518chroot <jail dir>
519 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
520 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
521 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
522 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
523 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
524 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100525
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100526cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
527 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
528 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
529 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100530 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
531 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
532 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
533 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
534 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
535 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
536 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
537 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
538 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
539 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100540
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200541crt-base <dir>
542 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
543 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
544 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546daemon
547 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
548 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
549 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
550
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900551external-check
552 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
553 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
554 See "option external-check".
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556gid <number>
557 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
558 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
559 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100560 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
561 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564group <group name>
565 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
566 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200568log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
570 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 configured with "log global".
572
573 <address> can be one of:
574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
577 port).
578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
585 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
586 writeable).
587
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100588 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
589 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
590 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
591 in Bourne shell.
592
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200593 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
594 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
595 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
596 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
597 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
598 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
599 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
600 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
601 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
602 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
603 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
604
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100605 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606
607 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
608 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
609 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
610
611 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200612 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
613 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
614 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
615 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
616 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
617 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200619 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100621log-send-hostname [<string>]
622 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
623 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
624 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
625 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
626 the logs.
627
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000628log-tag <string>
629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
630 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
631 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100632 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634nbproc <number>
635 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
636 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
637 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
638 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
639 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
640
641pidfile <pidfile>
642 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
643 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
644 starting the process. See also "daemon".
645
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200647 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
648 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
649 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
650 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
651 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
652 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100653 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200654 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
655 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100657ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
659 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100661 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
662 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
663 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
664 "bind" keyword for more information.
665
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100666ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
668 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
669 keyword to see available options.
670
671 Example:
672 global
673 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
674
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100675ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
677 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300678 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100679 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
680 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
681 information.
682
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100683ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
685 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
686 keyword to see available options.
687
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100688ssl-server-verify [none|required]
689 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
690 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
691 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
694 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
695 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
696 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
697 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200698
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200699 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
700 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
701 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200702
703stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
704 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
705 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100706 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200707
708stats maxconn <connections>
709 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
710 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
711
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200712uid <number>
713 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
714 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
715 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
716 one. See also "gid" and "user".
717
718ulimit-n <number>
719 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
720 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
721 option.
722
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100723unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
724 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
725
726 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
727 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
728 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
729 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
730 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
731 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
732 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
733 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
734 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
735 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737user <user name>
738 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
739 See also "uid" and "group".
740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200741node <name>
742 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
743
744 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
745 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
746 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
747 traffic.
748
749description <text>
750 Add a text that describes the instance.
751
752 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
753 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
754 "<" and ">" characters.
755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007573.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200758-----------------------
759
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200760max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
761 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
762 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
763 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
764 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
765 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
766 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
767 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
768 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770maxconn <number>
771 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
772 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
773 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200774 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
775 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
776 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
777 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100778 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
779 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
780 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
781 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
782 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200783
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200784maxconnrate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
786 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
787 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
788 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
789 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
790 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
791 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
792 fairness.
793
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100794maxcomprate <number>
795 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300796 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100797 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
798 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
799 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
800 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
801 default value.
802
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100803maxcompcpuusage <number>
804 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
805 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
806 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
807 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
808 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
809 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
810 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
811 process down and from introducing high latencies.
812
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100813maxpipes <number>
814 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
815 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
816 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
817 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
818 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
819 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
820
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200821maxsessrate <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
823 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
824 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
825 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
826 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
827 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
828 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
829 fairness.
830
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200831maxsslconn <number>
832 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
833 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
834 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
835 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
836 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
837 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
838 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100839 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
840 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
841 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
842 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
843 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
844 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
845 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200846
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200847maxsslrate <number>
848 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
849 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
850 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
851 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
852 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
853 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
854 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
855 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
856 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
857 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
858
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100859maxzlibmem <number>
860 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
861 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
862 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100863 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
864 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
865 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
866
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200867noepoll
868 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
869 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100870 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200871
872nokqueue
873 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
874 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
875 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
876
877nopoll
878 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
879 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100880 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100881 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200882
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100883nosplice
884 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
885 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
886 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100887 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100888 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
889 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
890 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
891 "option splice-response".
892
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300893nogetaddrinfo
894 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
895 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
896
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200897spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900898 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
899 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
900 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
901 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
902 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
903 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200904
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +0100905tune.buffers.limit <number>
906 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
907 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
908 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
909 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
910 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
911 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
912 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
913 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
914 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
915 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
916 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
917 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
918 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
919 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
920 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
921
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +0100922tune.buffers.reserve <number>
923 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
924 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
925 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
926 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
927
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200928tune.bufsize <number>
929 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
930 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
931 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
932 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
933 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
934 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
935 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
936 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400937 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
938 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
939 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200940
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200941tune.chksize <number>
942 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
943 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
944 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
945 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
946 checks whenever possible.
947
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100948tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
949 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
950 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
951 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
952 this value. The default value is 1.
953
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100954tune.http.cookielen <number>
955 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
956 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
957 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
958 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
959 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
960 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
961 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
962 to change this value.
963
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200964tune.http.maxhdr <number>
965 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
966 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
967 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
968 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
969 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
970 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
971 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
972 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
973 limit too high.
974
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100975tune.idletimer <timeout>
976 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
977 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
978 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
979 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
980 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
981 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
982 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
983 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
984 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
985
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100986tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100987 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
988 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
989 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
990 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
991 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
992 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
993 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
994 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
995 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
996 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100997
998tune.maxpollevents <number>
999 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1000 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1001 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1002 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1003 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1004
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001005tune.maxrewrite <number>
1006 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1007 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1008 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1009 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1010 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1011 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1012 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1013 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1014 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1015 bufsize.
1016
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001017tune.pipesize <number>
1018 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1019 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1020 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1021 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1022 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1023 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1024
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001025tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1026tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1027 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1028 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1029 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1030 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1031 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1032 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1033 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1034
1035tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1036tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1037 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1038 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1039 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1040 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1041 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1042 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1043 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1044 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1045 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1046 notifying haproxy again.
1047
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001048tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001049 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1050 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1051 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001052 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001053 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1054 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1055 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1056 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1057 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001058 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1059 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001060
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001061tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1062 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1063 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1064 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1065 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1066 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1067 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1068
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001069tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1070 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001071 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001072 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1073 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1074 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1075 being used for too long.
1076
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001077tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1078 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1079 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1080 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1081 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1082 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1083 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1084 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1085 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1086 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1087 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001088 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1089 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001090
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001091tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1092 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1093 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1094 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1095 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1096 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1097 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1098 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1099 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1100
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001101tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1102 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001103 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001104 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1105 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1106 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1107
1108tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1109 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1110 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1111 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1112 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011143.3. Debugging
1115--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116
1117debug
1118 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1119 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1120 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1121 system startup.
1122
1123quiet
1124 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1125 line argument "-q".
1126
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011283.4. Userlists
1129--------------
1130It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1131http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1132it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1133
1134userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001135 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001136 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1137
1138group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001139 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001140 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1141 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1142
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001143user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1144 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001145 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1146 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001147 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1148 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001149 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001150 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001151
1152
1153 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001154 userlist L1
1155 group G1 users tiger,scott
1156 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001157
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001158 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1159 user scott insecure-password elgato
1160 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001161
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001162 userlist L2
1163 group G1
1164 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001165
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001166 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1167 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1168 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001169
1170 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001171
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001172
11733.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001174----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001175It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1176haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1177pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1178identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1179or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1180Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1181known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1182the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1183process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1184during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1185tables.
1186
1187peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001188 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001189 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1190
1191peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1192 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1193 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1194 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1195 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1196 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1197 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1198
1199 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1200 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1201
1202 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1203 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1204 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1205 across all peers.
1206
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001207 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1208 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1209 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1210
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001211 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001212 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001213 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1214 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1215 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001216
1217 backend mybackend
1218 mode tcp
1219 balance roundrobin
1220 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1221 stick on src
1222
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001223 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1224 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001225
1226
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090012273.6. Mailers
1228------------
1229It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1230If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1231in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1232
1233mailer <mailersect>
1234 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1235 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1236
1237mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1238 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1239
1240 Example:
1241 mailers mymailers
1242 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1243 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1244
1245 backend mybackend
1246 mode tcp
1247 balance roundrobin
1248
1249 email-alert mailers mymailers
1250 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1251 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1252
1253 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1254 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1255
1256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012574. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001258----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001259
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001260Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1261 - defaults <name>
1262 - frontend <name>
1263 - backend <name>
1264 - listen <name>
1265
1266A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1267its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1268section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001269section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001270
1271A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1272connections.
1273
1274A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1275to forward incoming connections.
1276
1277A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1278parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1279
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001280All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1281'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1282case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1283
1284Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1285logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1286proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1287However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1288name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1289
1290Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1291and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001292bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001293protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1294modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1295arbitrary criteria.
1296
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001297In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1298a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1299the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1300
1301 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1302 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1303 between responses and new requests.
1304
1305 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1306 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1307 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1308 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1309
1310 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1311 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1312 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1313
1314 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1315 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1316 client-facing connection remains open.
1317
1318 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1319 after the end of the response.
1320
1321The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1322frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1323following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1324weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1325
1326 Backend mode
1327
1328 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1329 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1330 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1331 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1332 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1333 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1334 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1335 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1336 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1337 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1338 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001340
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013424.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1343--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001345The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1346limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1347they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1348limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001349marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001350option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001351and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1352with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1353specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001354
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001355
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001356 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1357------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1358acl - X X X
1359appsession - - X X
1360backlog X X X -
1361balance X - X X
1362bind - X X -
1363bind-process X X X X
1364block - X X X
1365capture cookie - X X -
1366capture request header - X X -
1367capture response header - X X -
1368clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001369compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001370contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1371cookie X - X X
1372default-server X - X X
1373default_backend X X X -
1374description - X X X
1375disabled X X X X
1376dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001377email-alert from X X X X
1378email-alert mailers X X X X
1379email-alert myhostname X X X X
1380email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001381enabled X X X X
1382errorfile X X X X
1383errorloc X X X X
1384errorloc302 X X X X
1385-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1386errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001387force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001388fullconn X - X X
1389grace X X X X
1390hash-type X - X X
1391http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001392http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001393http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001394http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001395http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001396http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001397id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001398ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001399log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001400log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001401log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001402max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001403maxconn X X X -
1404mode X X X X
1405monitor fail - X X -
1406monitor-net X X X -
1407monitor-uri X X X -
1408option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1409option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1410option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1411option allbackups (*) X - X X
1412option checkcache (*) X - X X
1413option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1414option contstats (*) X X X -
1415option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1416option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1417option forceclose (*) X X X X
1418-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1419option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001420option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001421option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001422option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001423option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001424option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001425option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1426option httpchk X - X X
1427option httpclose (*) X X X X
1428option httplog X X X X
1429option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001430option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001431option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001432option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001433option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1434option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1435option logasap (*) X X X -
1436option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001437option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001438option nolinger (*) X X X X
1439option originalto X X X X
1440option persist (*) X - X X
1441option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001442option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001443option smtpchk X - X X
1444option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1445option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1446option splice-request (*) X X X X
1447option splice-response (*) X X X X
1448option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1449option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1450-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001451option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001452option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1453option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1454option tcpka X X X X
1455option tcplog X X X X
1456option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001457external-check command X - X X
1458external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001459persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1460rate-limit sessions X X X -
1461redirect - X X X
1462redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1463redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1464reqadd - X X X
1465reqallow - X X X
1466reqdel - X X X
1467reqdeny - X X X
1468reqiallow - X X X
1469reqidel - X X X
1470reqideny - X X X
1471reqipass - X X X
1472reqirep - X X X
1473reqisetbe - X X X
1474reqitarpit - X X X
1475reqpass - X X X
1476reqrep - X X X
1477-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1478reqsetbe - X X X
1479reqtarpit - X X X
1480retries X - X X
1481rspadd - X X X
1482rspdel - X X X
1483rspdeny - X X X
1484rspidel - X X X
1485rspideny - X X X
1486rspirep - X X X
1487rsprep - X X X
1488server - - X X
1489source X - X X
1490srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001491stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001492stats auth X - X X
1493stats enable X - X X
1494stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001495stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001496stats realm X - X X
1497stats refresh X - X X
1498stats scope X - X X
1499stats show-desc X - X X
1500stats show-legends X - X X
1501stats show-node X - X X
1502stats uri X - X X
1503-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1504stick match - - X X
1505stick on - - X X
1506stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001507stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001508stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001509tcp-check connect - - X X
1510tcp-check expect - - X X
1511tcp-check send - - X X
1512tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001513tcp-request connection - X X -
1514tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001515tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001516tcp-response content - - X X
1517tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001518timeout check X - X X
1519timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001520timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001521timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1522timeout connect X - X X
1523timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1524timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1525timeout http-request X X X X
1526timeout queue X - X X
1527timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001528timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001529timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1530timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001531timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001532transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001533unique-id-format X X X -
1534unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001535use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001536use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001537------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1538 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001539
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001540
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015414.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1542---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001543
1544This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1545
1546
1547acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1548 Declare or complete an access list.
1549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1550 no | yes | yes | yes
1551 Example:
1552 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1553 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1554 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001556 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001557
1558
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001559appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1560 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001561 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1563 no | no | yes | yes
1564 Arguments :
1565 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1566 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1567
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001568 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001569 checked in each cookie value.
1570
1571 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1572 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1573 milliseconds.
1574
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001575 request-learn
1576 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1577 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1578 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1579 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1580 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1581 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1582
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001583 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1584 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1585 data following this prefix.
1586
1587 Example :
1588 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1589
1590 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1591 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1592
1593 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1594 2 modes are currently supported :
1595 - path-parameters :
1596 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1597 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1598 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1599 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1600 - query-string :
1601 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1602 query string.
1603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001604 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1605 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1606 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1607 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001608 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1609 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1610 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001611 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1612 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1613
1614 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1615
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001616 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1617 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1618 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001620 Example :
1621 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1622
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001623 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1624 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001625
1626
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001627backlog <conns>
1628 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1630 yes | yes | yes | no
1631 Arguments :
1632 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1633 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001634 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001635
1636 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1637 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1638 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1639 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1640 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1641 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1642 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1643 backlog parameter.
1644
1645 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1646 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1647 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1648
1649 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1650
1651
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001652balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001653balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001654 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1656 yes | no | yes | yes
1657 Arguments :
1658 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1659 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1660 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1661 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1662
1663 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1664 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1665 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1666 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001667 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001668 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001669 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1670 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1671 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1672 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1673 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1674 it, so that you don't worry.
1675
1676 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1677 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1678 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1679 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1680 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1681 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1682 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1683 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001684
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001685 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1686 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1687 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1688 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1689 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1690 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1691 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1692 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1693
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001694 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001695 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001696 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1697 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001698 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001699 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1700 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1701 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1702 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1703 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001704 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1705 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1706 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1707 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1708 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1709 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001710
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001711 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1712 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1713 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1714 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1715 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1716 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1717 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1718 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001719 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001720 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001721 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1722 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1723 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001724
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001725 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1726 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1727 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1728 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1729 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1730 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1731 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1732 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1733 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1734 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1735 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1736 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001737
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001738 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001739 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1740 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1741 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1742 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1743 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1744 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1745 URIs start with a leading "/".
1746
1747 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1748 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1749 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1750 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001752 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001753 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1754
1755 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001756 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1757 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001758 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1759 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1760 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1761 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001762 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001763 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1764 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001765
1766 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1767 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1768 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1769 server will receive the request.
1770
1771 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1772 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1773 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1774 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1775 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001776 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1777 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1778 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001779
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001780 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1781 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1782 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1783 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1784 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001785
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001786 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001787 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1788 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1789 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1790
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001791 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1792 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1793 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1794
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001795 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001796 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001797 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1798 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1799 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1800 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1801 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1802 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001803 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001804 used instead.
1805
1806 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1807 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1808 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1809 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1810
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001811 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1812 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1813 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1814
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001815 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001817 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001818 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1819 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001820
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001821 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1822 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1823 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001824
1825 Examples :
1826 balance roundrobin
1827 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001828 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001829 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1830 balance hdr(host)
1831 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001832
1833 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1834 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001836 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001837 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1838 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1839 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1840 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1841
1842 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1843 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1844 defaults to 16 kB.
1845
1846 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1847 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1848
1849 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1850 Round Robin.
1851
1852 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1853 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1854 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1855 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1856
1857 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1858
1859 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001860 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001861 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1862 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1863 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001864
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001865 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1866 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001867
1868
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001869bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1870bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001871 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1873 no | yes | yes | no
1874 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001875 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1876 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1877 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1878 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001879 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001880 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1881 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1882 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1883 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1884 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1885 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1886 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001887 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1888 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1889 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1890 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1891 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1892 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1893 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001894 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1895 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1896 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001897 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1898 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1899 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1900 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001901
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001902 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1903 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001904 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1905 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1906 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001907 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1908 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1909 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1910 the range.
1911
1912 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1913 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1914 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1915 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1916 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1917 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1918 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001919 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001920 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001921
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001922 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1923 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1924 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1925 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1926 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1927 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1928 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1929 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1930
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001931 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1932 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1933 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1934 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001935
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001936 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1937 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1938 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1939 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1940 in a frontend.
1941
1942 Example :
1943 listen http_proxy
1944 bind :80,:443
1945 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001946 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001947
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001948 listen http_https_proxy
1949 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001950 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001951
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001952 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1953 bind ipv6@:80
1954 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1955 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1956
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001957 listen external_bind_app1
1958 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1959
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001960 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001961 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001962
1963
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001964bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001965 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1967 yes | yes | yes | yes
1968 Arguments :
1969 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1970 may be used to override a default value.
1971
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001972 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001973 option may be combined with other numbers.
1974
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001975 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001976 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1977 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1978 missing from all processes.
1979
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001980 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001981 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001982 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1983 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1984 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1985 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001986
1987 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1988 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1989 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1990 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1991 and 'even' instances.
1992
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001993 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1994 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1995 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1996 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001997
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001998 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1999 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2000
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002001 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2002 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2003 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2004
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002005 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2006 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2007
2008 Example :
2009 listen app_ip1
2010 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002011 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002012
2013 listen app_ip2
2014 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002015 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002016
2017 listen management
2018 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002019 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002020
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002021 listen management
2022 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2023 bind-process 1-4
2024
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002025 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002026
2027
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002028block { if | unless } <condition>
2029 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2031 no | yes | yes | yes
2032
2033 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2034 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002035 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002036 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002037 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2038 "block" statements per instance.
2039
2040 Example:
2041 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2042 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2043 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2044 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002046 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002047
2048
2049capture cookie <name> len <length>
2050 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2052 no | yes | yes | no
2053 Arguments :
2054 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2055 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2056 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2057 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2058 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2059
2060 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2061 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2062 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2063 right if it exceeds <length>.
2064
2065 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2066 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2067 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2068 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2069
2070 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2071 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2072 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2073
2074 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2075 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2076 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002077 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2078 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2079 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002080
2081 Example:
2082 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2083
2084 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002085 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086
2087
2088capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002089 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2091 no | yes | yes | no
2092 Arguments :
2093 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002094 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002095 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2096 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2097 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2098
2099 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2100 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2101 it exceeds <length>.
2102
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002103 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002104 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2105 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002106 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2107 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2108 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2109 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002110 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002111 environments to find where the request came from.
2112
2113 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2114 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2115 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2116 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002117
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002118 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2119 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2120 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2121 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2122 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002123
2124 Example:
2125 capture request header Host len 15
2126 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2127 capture request header Referrer len 15
2128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002129 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002130 about logging.
2131
2132
2133capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002134 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2136 no | yes | yes | no
2137 Arguments :
2138 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002139 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002140 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2141 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2142 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2143
2144 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2145 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2146 it exceeds <length>.
2147
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002148 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002149 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2150 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2151 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002152 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2153 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2154 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2155 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002156
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002157 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2158 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2159 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2160 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2161 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002162
2163 Example:
2164 capture response header Content-length len 9
2165 capture response header Location len 15
2166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002167 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002168 about logging.
2169
2170
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002171clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002172 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2174 yes | yes | yes | no
2175 Arguments :
2176 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2177 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2178 as explained at the top of this document.
2179
2180 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2181 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2182 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2183 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2184 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2185 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2186 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2187 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002188 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002189 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2190 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2191
2192 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2193 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2194 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2195 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2196 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2197 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2198
2199 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2200 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2201
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002202 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2203 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002205compression algo <algorithm> ...
2206compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002207compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002208 Enable HTTP compression.
2209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2210 yes | yes | yes | yes
2211 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002212 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2213 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2214 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2215
2216 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002217 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002218 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2219 data.
2220
2221 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2222 support for zlib was built in.
2223
2224 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2225 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2226 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2227 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2228 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2229 in.
2230
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002231 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002232 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002233 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2234 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2235 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2236 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2237 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002238
2239 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2240 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2241 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2242 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2243 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002244 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2245 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2246 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2247 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2248 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002249 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2250 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002251
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002252 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002253 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2254 "Accept-Encoding" header
2255 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002256 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002257 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2258 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002259 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2260 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2261 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2262 "multipart"
2263 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2264 header
2265 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2266 and later
2267 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2268 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002269
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002270 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2271 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002272
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002273 Examples :
2274 compression algo gzip
2275 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002276
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002277contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002278 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2280 yes | no | yes | yes
2281 Arguments :
2282 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2283 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2284 as explained at the top of this document.
2285
2286 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002287 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002288 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002289 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2290 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2291 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2292 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2293
2294 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2295 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2296 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2297 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2298 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2299 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2300
2301 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2302 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2303 instead.
2304
2305 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2306 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2307
2308
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002309cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002310 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2311 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002312 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2314 yes | no | yes | yes
2315 Arguments :
2316 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2317 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2318 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2319 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2320 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2321 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2322 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2323 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2324 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2325
2326 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2327 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2328 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2329 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2330 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2331 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2332 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2333 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2334 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2335 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2336 "insert" and "prefix".
2337
2338 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002339 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002340
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002341 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002342 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2343 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2344 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2345 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2346 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2347 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2348 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2349 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2350 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2351 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352
2353 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2354 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2355 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2356 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2357 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2358 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2359 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2360 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2361 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2362 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002363 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2364 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2365 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002366
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002367 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2368 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2369 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002370 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2371 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2372 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2373 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002374 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2375 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2376 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002377
2378 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2379 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2380 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2381 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2382 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2383 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2384 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2385 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2386 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2387
2388 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2389 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2390 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2391 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2392 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2393 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2394 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2395 persistence cookie in the cache.
2396 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2397
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002398 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2399 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2400 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2401 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2402 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2403 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2404 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2405 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2406 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2407 they logout.
2408
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002409 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2410 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2411 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2412 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2413
2414 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2415 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2416 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2417 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2418 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2419 this attribute.
2420
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002421 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002422 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002423 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2424 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2425 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2426 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2427 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2428 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002429
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002430 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2431 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2432 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2433 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2434 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2435 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2436 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2437 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2438 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2439 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2440 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2441 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2442 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2443 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2444 the site.
2445
2446 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2447 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2448 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2449 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2450 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2451 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2452 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2453 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2454 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2455 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2456 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2457 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2458 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2459 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2460 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2461 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002463 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2464 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2465 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2466 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 Examples :
2469 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2470 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2471 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002472 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002473
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002474 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002475 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002476
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002477
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002478default-server [param*]
2479 Change default options for a server in a backend
2480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2481 yes | no | yes | yes
2482 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002483 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2484 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2485 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2486 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002487
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002488 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002489 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2490
2491 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002492
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002493
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002494default_backend <backend>
2495 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2497 yes | yes | yes | no
2498 Arguments :
2499 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2500
2501 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2502 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2503 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2504 will catch all undetermined requests.
2505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002506 Example :
2507
2508 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2509 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2510 default_backend dynamic
2511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002512 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2513
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002514
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002515description <string>
2516 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2518 no | yes | yes | yes
2519 Arguments : string
2520
2521 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2522 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2523 it describes.
2524 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2525
2526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002527disabled
2528 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2530 yes | yes | yes | yes
2531 Arguments : none
2532
2533 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2534 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2535 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2536 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2537 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2538 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2539 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2540
2541 See also : "enabled"
2542
2543
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002544dispatch <address>:<port>
2545 Set a default server address
2546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2547 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002548 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002549
2550 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2551 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2552 during start-up.
2553
2554 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2555 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2556 possible with normal servers.
2557
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002558 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002559 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2560 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2561 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2562 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2563
2564 See also : "server"
2565
2566
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002567enabled
2568 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2570 yes | yes | yes | yes
2571 Arguments : none
2572
2573 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2574 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2575
2576 See also : "disabled"
2577
2578
2579errorfile <code> <file>
2580 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2582 yes | yes | yes | yes
2583 Arguments :
2584 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002585 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002586
2587 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002588 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002589 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002590 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2591 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002592
2593 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2594 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2595 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2596
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002597 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2598
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002599 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2600 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2601 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2602 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2603
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002604 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2605 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2606 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2607 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2608 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2609 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2610
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002611 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2612 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2613 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002614 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002615 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2616
2617 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2618
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002619 Example :
2620 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002621 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002622 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2623 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2624
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002625
2626errorloc <code> <url>
2627errorloc302 <code> <url>
2628 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2630 yes | yes | yes | yes
2631 Arguments :
2632 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002633 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002634
2635 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2636 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2637 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2638 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2639 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2640
2641 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2642 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2643 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2644
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002645 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2646
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002647 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2648 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2649 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2650 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2651 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2652 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2653 request.
2654
2655 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2656
2657
2658errorloc303 <code> <url>
2659 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2661 yes | yes | yes | yes
2662 Arguments :
2663 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2664 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2665
2666 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2667 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2668 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2669 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2670 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2671
2672 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2673 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2674 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2675
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002676 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2677
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002678 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2679 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2680 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2681 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002682 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002683
2684 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2685
2686
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002687email-alert from <emailaddr>
2688 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2689 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2690 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2691 yes | yes | yes | yes
2692
2693 Arguments :
2694
2695 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2696
2697 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2698 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2699
2700 See also : "email-alert mailers", "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
2701 section 3.6 about mailers.
2702
2703
2704email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2705 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2706 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2707 yes | yes | yes | yes
2708
2709 Arguments :
2710
2711 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2712
2713 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2714 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2715
2716 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
2717 section 3.6 about mailers.
2718
2719
2720email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2721 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2722 mailers.
2723 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2724 yes | yes | yes | yes
2725
2726 Arguments :
2727
2728 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2729
2730 By default the systems hostname is used.
2731
2732 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2733 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2734 for the proxy.
2735
2736 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers", "email-alert to",
2737 section 3.6 about mailers.
2738
2739
2740email-alert to <emailaddr>
2741 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
2742 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
2743 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2744 yes | yes | yes | yes
2745
2746 Arguments :
2747
2748 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2749
2750 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2751 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2752
2753 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2754 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
2755
2756
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002757force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2758 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2759 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2760 no | yes | yes | yes
2761
2762 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2763 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2764 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2765 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2766 marked down for maintenance operations.
2767
2768 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2769 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2770 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2771 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2772 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2773 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2774 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2775 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2776 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2777
2778 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2779 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2780 is used.
2781
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002782 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002783 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002784
2785
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002786fullconn <conns>
2787 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2789 yes | no | yes | yes
2790 Arguments :
2791 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2792 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2793
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002794 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002795 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002796 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002797 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2798 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2799 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2800 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2801 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002802 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002803
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002804 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2805 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002806 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2807 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2808 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002809
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002810 Example :
2811 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2812 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2813 # connections.
2814 backend dynamic
2815 fullconn 10000
2816 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2817 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2818
2819 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2820
2821
2822grace <time>
2823 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002825 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002826 Arguments :
2827 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2828 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2829 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2830
2831 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2832 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002833 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002834 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2835
2836 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2837 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2838 simplify it.
2839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002841hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002842 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2844 yes | no | yes | yes
2845 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002846 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2847 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002848
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002849 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2850 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2851 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2852 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2853 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2854 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2855 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2856 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2857 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2858 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002859
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002860 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2861 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2862 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2863 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2864 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2865 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2866 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2867 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2868 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2869 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2870 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2871 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2872 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002873 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2874 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002875
2876 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2877
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002878 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002879 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2880 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2881 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002882 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2883 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2884 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002885
2886 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2887 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002888 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2889 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2890 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2891 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2892
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002893 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2894 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2895 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2896 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2897 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2898 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2899 parameter.
2900
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01002901 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
2902 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
2903 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
2904 used on strings.
2905
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002906 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2907
2908 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2909 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2910 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2911 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2912 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2913 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2914 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2915 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2916 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2917 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2918 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2919 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002920
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002921 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2922 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2923 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002924
2925 See also : "balance", "server"
2926
2927
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002928http-check disable-on-404
2929 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002931 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002932 Arguments : none
2933
2934 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2935 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2936 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2937 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2938 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2939 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2940 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2941 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002942 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2943 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2944 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2945
2946 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2947
2948
2949http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002950 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002952 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002953 Arguments :
2954 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2955 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002956 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002957 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2958 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2959 details on the supported keywords.
2960
2961 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2962 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2963 with the usual backslash ('\').
2964
2965 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2966 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2967 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2968 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2969 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2970
2971 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002972 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002973 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2974 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2975 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2976
2977 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002978 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002979 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2980 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2981 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2982 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2983
2984 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002985 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002986 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2987 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2988 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2989 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2990 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2991 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2992 trace).
2993
2994 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002995 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002996 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2997 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2998 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2999 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3000 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3001 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3002
3003 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3004 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3005 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3006 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3007 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3008 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3009 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3010 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3011
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003012 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3013 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3014 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3015
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003016 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3017 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3018
3019 Examples :
3020 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003021 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003022
3023 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003024 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003025
3026 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003027 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003028
3029 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003030 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003031
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003032 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003033
3034
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003035http-check send-state
3036 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3038 yes | no | yes | yes
3039 Arguments : none
3040
3041 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3042 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3043 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3044 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3045 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3046
3047 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3048 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3049 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3050 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3051 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
3052 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3053 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3054 checked in multiple backends.
3055
3056 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3057 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3058
3059 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3060 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3061 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3062 one fails.
3063
3064 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3065 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3066 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3067
3068 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3069 server's queue.
3070
3071 Example of a header received by the application server :
3072 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3073 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3074
3075 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3076
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003077http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003078 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003079 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003080 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3081 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003082 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3083 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003084 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3085 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3086 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003087 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
3088 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003089 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003090 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003091 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3092
3093 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3094 no | yes | yes | yes
3095
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003096 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3097 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3098 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3099 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3100 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003101
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003102 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3103 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3104 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3105
3106 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3107 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3108 are evaluated.
3109
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003110 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3111 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3112 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3113 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3114 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3115 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3116 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3117 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3118 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003119 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003120 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3121
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003122 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3123 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3124 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3125 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3126 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3127
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003128 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3129 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3130 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003131 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3132 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003133
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003134 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3135 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3136 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3137 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3138 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3139 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3140 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3141 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3142
3143 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3144 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3145 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003146 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3147 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003148
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003149 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3150 <name>.
3151
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003152 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3153 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3154 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3155 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3156 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3157 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3158 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3159 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3160
3161 Example:
3162
3163 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3164
3165 applied to:
3166
3167 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3168
3169 outputs:
3170
3171 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3172
3173 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3174
3175 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3176 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3177 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3178 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3179 header.
3180
3181 Example:
3182
3183 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3184
3185 applied to:
3186
3187 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3188
3189 outputs:
3190
3191 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3192
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003193 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3194 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3195 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3196 it.
3197
3198 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3199 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3200 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3201 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3202 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3203 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3204
3205 Example :
3206 # prepend the host name before the path
3207 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3208
3209 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3210 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3211 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3212 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3213 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3214 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3215 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3216 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3217
3218 Example :
3219 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3220 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3221
3222 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3223 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3224 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3225 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3226 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3227 "set-query".
3228
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003229 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3230 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3231 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3232 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3233 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3234 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3235 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3236 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3237
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003238 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3239 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3240 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3241 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3242 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3243 another equipment.
3244
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003245 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3246 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3247 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3248 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3249 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3250 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3251 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3252 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3253
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003254 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3255 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3256 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3257 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3258 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3259 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3260 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3261 admin privileges.
3262
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003263 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3264 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3265 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3266 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3267 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3268 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3269 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3270 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3271
3272 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3273 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3274 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3275 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3276 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3277 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3278
3279 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3280 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3281 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3282 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3283 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3284 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3285
3286 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3287 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3288 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3289 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3290 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3291 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3292 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3293 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3294 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3295
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003296 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3297 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3298 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3299 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3300 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3301 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3302 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3303 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3304 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3305 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3306 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3307 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3308
3309 These actions take one or two arguments :
3310 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3311 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3312 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3313 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3314
3315 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3316 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3317 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3318 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3319
3320 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3321 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3322 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3323 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3324 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3325 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3326 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3327 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3328
3329 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3330 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3331 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3332 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3333 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3334
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003335 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3336
3337 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3338 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3339 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3340 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003341
3342 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003343 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3344 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3345 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003346
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003347 http-request allow if nagios
3348 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3349 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3350 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003351
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003352 Example:
3353 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003354 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003355
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003356 Example:
3357 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3358 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3359 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3360 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3361 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3362 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3363 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3364 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3365 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3366
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003367 Example:
3368 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3369 acl add path /addacl
3370 acl del path /delacl
3371
3372 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3373
3374 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3375 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3376
3377 Example:
3378 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3379 acl setmap path /setmap
3380 acl delmap path /delmap
3381
3382 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3383
3384 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3385 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3386
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003387 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3388 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003389
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003390http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003391 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003392 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3393 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003394 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3395 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3396 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3397 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3398 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3399 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003400 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003401 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3402
3403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3404 no | yes | yes | yes
3405
3406 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3407 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3408 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3409 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3410 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3411 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3412
3413 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3414 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3415 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3416 current section.
3417
3418 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3419 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3420 rules are evaluated.
3421
3422 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3423 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3424 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3425 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3426 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3427 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3428 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3429
3430 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3431 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3432 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3433 external users.
3434
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003435 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3436 <name>.
3437
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003438 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3439 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3440 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3441 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3442 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3443 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3444 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3445 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3446
3447 Example:
3448
3449 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3450
3451 applied to:
3452
3453 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3454
3455 outputs:
3456
3457 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3458
3459 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3460
3461 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3462 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3463 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3464 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3465 header.
3466
3467 Example:
3468
3469 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3470
3471 applied to:
3472
3473 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3474
3475 outputs:
3476
3477 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3478
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003479 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3480 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3481 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3482 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3483 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3484 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3485 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3486 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3487
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003488 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3489 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3490 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3491 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3492 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3493 another equipment.
3494
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003495 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3496 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3497 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3498 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3499 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3500 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3501 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3502 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3503
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003504 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3505 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3506 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3507 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3508 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3509 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3510 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3511 admin privileges.
3512
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003513 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3514 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3515 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3516 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3517 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3518 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3519 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3520 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3521
3522 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3523 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3524 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3525 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3526 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3527 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3528
3529 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3530 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3531 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3532 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3533 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3534 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3535
3536 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3537 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3538 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3539 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3540 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3541 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3542 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3543 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3544 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3545
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003546 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3547
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003548 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003549 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3550 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3551 rules.
3552
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003553 Example:
3554 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3555
3556 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3557
3558 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3559 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3560
3561 Example:
3562 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3563
3564 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3565
3566 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3567 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3568
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003569 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3570 ACL usage.
3571
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003572
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003573http-send-name-header [<header>]
3574 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3575
3576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3577 yes | no | yes | yes
3578
3579 Arguments :
3580
3581 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3582
3583 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3584 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3585 is added with the header string proved.
3586
3587 See also : "server"
3588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003589id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003590 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3592 no | yes | yes | yes
3593 Arguments : none
3594
3595 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3596 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3597 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003598
3599
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003600ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3601 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3602 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3603 no | yes | yes | yes
3604
3605 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3606 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3607 and running).
3608
3609 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3610 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3611 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003612 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003613 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3614
3615 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3616 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3617
3618 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3619 "unless" condition is met.
3620
3621 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3622
3623
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003624log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003625log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003626no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003627 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3629 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003630
3631 Prefix :
3632 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3633 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3634 prefix does not allow arguments.
3635
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003636 Arguments :
3637 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3638 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3639 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3640 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3641 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3642 parameter.
3643
3644 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3645 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3646
3647 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3648 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3649 standard syslog port).
3650
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003651 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3652 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3653 standard syslog port).
3654
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003655 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3656 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3657 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3658 appropriately writeable).
3659
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003660 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3661 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3662 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3663 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3664
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003665 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3666 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3667 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3668 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3669 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3670 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3671 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3672 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3673 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3674 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3675 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3676
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003677 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3678
3679 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3680 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3681 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3682
3683 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3684 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3685 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003686 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3687 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3688 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3689 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3690 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003691
3692 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3693
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003694 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3695 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3696 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003697
3698 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3699 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3700 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3701 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3702
3703 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3704 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003705
3706 Example :
3707 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003708 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3709 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003710 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3711
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003712
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003713log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003714 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3715 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3716 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003717
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003718 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3719 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3720 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3721 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3722 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003723
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003724log-tag <string>
3725 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
3726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3727 yes | yes | yes | yes
3728
3729 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
3730 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
3731 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
3732 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
3733 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
3734 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
3735 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
3736 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
3737 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003738
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003739max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3740 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3741 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3742 yes | no | yes | yes
3743
3744 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3745 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3746 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3747 servers.
3748
3749 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3750 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3751 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3752 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3753 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3754 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3755 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3756 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3757 picking a different server.
3758
3759 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3760 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3761 even if they have to be queued.
3762
3763 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3764 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3765
3766
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003767maxconn <conns>
3768 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3770 yes | yes | yes | no
3771 Arguments :
3772 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3773 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3774 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3775 closes.
3776
3777 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3778 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3779 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3780 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3781 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3782 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3783 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3784 properly tuned.
3785
3786 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3787 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3788 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3789
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003790 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3791
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003792 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3793
3794
3795mode { tcp|http|health }
3796 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3798 yes | yes | yes | yes
3799 Arguments :
3800 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3801 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3802 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3803 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3804
3805 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3806 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3807 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3808 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3809 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3810
3811 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003812 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3813 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3814 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3815 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3816 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3817 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3818 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003819
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003820 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3821 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3822 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003823
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003824 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003825 defaults http_instances
3826 mode http
3827
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003828 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003829
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003830
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003831monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003832 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3834 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003835 Arguments :
3836 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3837 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003838 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003839 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3840 backend and its backup.
3841
3842 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3843 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3844 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3845 servers in a list of backends.
3846
3847 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3848 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3849 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3850 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3851 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3852 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3853 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003854 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3855 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003856
3857 Example:
3858 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003859 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003860 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3861 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3862 monitor-uri /site_alive
3863 monitor fail if site_dead
3864
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003865 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003866
3867
3868monitor-net <source>
3869 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3871 yes | yes | yes | no
3872 Arguments :
3873 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3874 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3875 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3876 followed by a mask.
3877
3878 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3879 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003880 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003881 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3882
3883 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3884 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3885 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3886 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003887 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3888 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3889 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003890
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003891 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3892 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3893 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3894 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3895 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3896 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003897
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003898 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3899 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003900
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003901 Example :
3902 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3903 frontend www
3904 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3905
3906 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3907
3908
3909monitor-uri <uri>
3910 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3912 yes | yes | yes | no
3913 Arguments :
3914 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3915 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3916
3917 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3918 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3919 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3920 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3921 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3922 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3923 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3924 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3925
3926 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3927 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3928 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3929 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3930 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3931 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3932
3933 Example :
3934 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3935 frontend www
3936 mode http
3937 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3938
3939 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003941
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003942option abortonclose
3943no option abortonclose
3944 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3946 yes | no | yes | yes
3947 Arguments : none
3948
3949 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3950 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3951 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3952 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003953 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003954 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3955 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3956 encountered while delivering the response.
3957
3958 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3959 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3960 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3961 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3962 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3963 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003964 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003965 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003966 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003967 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3968 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3969 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3970
3971 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3972 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3973 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3974 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3975 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3976 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3977 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3978 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003979 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003980
3981 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3982 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3983
3984 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3985
3986
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003987option accept-invalid-http-request
3988no option accept-invalid-http-request
3989 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3991 yes | yes | yes | no
3992 Arguments : none
3993
3994 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3995 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3996 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3997 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3998 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3999 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4000 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4001 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004002 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4003 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4004 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4005 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4006 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
4007 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004008
4009 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4010 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4011 been confirmed.
4012
4013 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4014 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004015 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4016 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004017 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4018
4019 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4020 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4021
4022 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4023 stats socket.
4024
4025
4026option accept-invalid-http-response
4027no option accept-invalid-http-response
4028 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4030 yes | no | yes | yes
4031 Arguments : none
4032
4033 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
4034 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4035 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4036 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4037 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4038 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4039 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4040 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
4041 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
4042
4043 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4044 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4045 been confirmed.
4046
4047 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4048 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4049 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4050 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4051
4052 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4053 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4054
4055 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4056 stats socket.
4057
4058
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004059option allbackups
4060no option allbackups
4061 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4063 yes | no | yes | yes
4064 Arguments : none
4065
4066 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4067 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4068 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4069 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4070 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4071 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4072 order between the backup servers anymore.
4073
4074 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4075 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4076
4077 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4078 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4079
4080
4081option checkcache
4082no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004083 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4085 yes | no | yes | yes
4086 Arguments : none
4087
4088 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4089 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004090 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004091 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4092 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004093 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004094
4095 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004096 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004097 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004098 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4099 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004100 to the client are :
4101 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004102 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004103 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004104 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4105 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4106 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4107 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4108 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4109 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4110 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4111 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4112 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4113 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4114 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4115
4116 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004117 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004118 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004119 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004120 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4121
4122 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4123 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004124 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004125 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4126
4127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4129
4130
4131option clitcpka
4132no option clitcpka
4133 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4135 yes | yes | yes | no
4136 Arguments : none
4137
4138 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4139 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4140 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4141 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4142
4143 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4144 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4145 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4146 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4147
4148 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4149 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4150 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4151 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4152 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4153
4154 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4155
4156 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4157 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4158 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4159
4160 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4161 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4162
4163 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4164
4165
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004166option contstats
4167 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4169 yes | yes | yes | no
4170 Arguments : none
4171
4172 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4173 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4174 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4175 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4176 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4177 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4178 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4179
4180
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004181option dontlog-normal
4182no option dontlog-normal
4183 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4185 yes | yes | yes | no
4186 Arguments : none
4187
4188 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4189 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4190 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4191 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4192 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4193 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4194 logged.
4195
4196 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4197 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4198 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004200 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004201 logging.
4202
4203
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004204option dontlognull
4205no option dontlognull
4206 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4208 yes | yes | yes | no
4209 Arguments : none
4210
4211 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4212 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4213 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4214 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4215 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4216 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
4217 which typically corresponds to those probes.
4218
4219 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4220 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4221 would not be logged.
4222
4223 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4224 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004226 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004227
4228
4229option forceclose
4230no option forceclose
4231 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004233 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004234 Arguments : none
4235
4236 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4237 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4238 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4239 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4240 global session times in the logs.
4241
4242 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004243 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004244 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004245
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004246 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4247 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4248 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4249
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004250 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4251 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004252
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004253 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4254 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4255
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004256 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004257
4258
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004259option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004260 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4262 yes | yes | yes | yes
4263 Arguments :
4264 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4265 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004266 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004267 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004268
4269 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4270 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4271 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4272 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4273 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4274 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4275 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004276 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4277 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4278 possible that the client has already brought one.
4279
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004280 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004281 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004282 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4283 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004284 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4285 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004286
4287 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4288 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4289 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4290 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4291 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4292 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4293 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4294
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004295 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4296 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4297 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4298 are under the control of the end-user.
4299
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004300 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004301 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4302 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004303 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4304 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4305 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004306
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004307 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004308 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4309 frontend www
4310 mode http
4311 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4312
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004313 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4314 backend www
4315 mode http
4316 option forwardfor header X-Client
4317
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004318 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004319 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004320
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004321
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004322option http-keep-alive
4323no option http-keep-alive
4324 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4326 yes | yes | yes | yes
4327 Arguments : none
4328
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004329 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4330 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4331 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4332 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4333 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4334 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4335 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4336
4337 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4338 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004339 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4340 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4341 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4342 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4343 situations where this option may be useful :
4344
4345 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4346 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4347
4348 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4349 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4350
4351 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4352 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4353 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4354 request.
4355
4356 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4357 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004358 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4359 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4360 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004361
4362 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4363 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4364
4365 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4366 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4367 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4368 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4369 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4370 not set.
4371
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004372 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4373 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004374 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004375 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004376
4377 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004378 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4379 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004380
4381
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004382option http-no-delay
4383no option http-no-delay
4384 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4386 yes | yes | yes | yes
4387 Arguments : none
4388
4389 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4390 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4391 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4392 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4393 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4394 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4395 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4396 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4397 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4398 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4399 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4400 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4401 affected.
4402
4403 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4404 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4405 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4406 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4407 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4408 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4409 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4410 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4411 latency environments.
4412
4413
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004414option http-pretend-keepalive
4415no option http-pretend-keepalive
4416 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4418 yes | yes | yes | yes
4419 Arguments : none
4420
4421 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4422 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4423 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4424 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4425 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4426 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4427 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4428 consider the response complete.
4429
4430 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4431 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4432 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4433 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4434 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4435 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4436
4437 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4438 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4439 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4440 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4441 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4442 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4443 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4444
4445 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4446 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004447 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004448 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4449 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004450
4451 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4452 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4453
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004454 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4455 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004456
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004457
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004458option http-server-close
4459no option http-server-close
4460 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4462 yes | yes | yes | yes
4463 Arguments : none
4464
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004465 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4466 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4467 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4468 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4469 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4470 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4471 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4472 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4473 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4474 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4475 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4476 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4477 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4478 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4479 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4480 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004481
4482 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4483 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4484 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4485 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004486 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4487 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004488
4489 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4490 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004491 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4492 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004493 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4494 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004495
4496 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4497 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4498
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004499 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004500 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4501 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004502
4503
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004504option http-tunnel
4505no option http-tunnel
4506 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4508 yes | yes | yes | yes
4509 Arguments : none
4510
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004511 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4512 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4513 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4514 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4515 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4516 "option http-tunnel".
4517
4518 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004519 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004520 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4521 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4522 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4523 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4524 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4525 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4526 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004527
4528 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4529 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4530
4531 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4532 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4533 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4534
4535
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004536option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004537no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004538 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4540 yes | yes | yes | no
4541 Arguments : none
4542
4543 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4544 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4545 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4546 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4547 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4548 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4549 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4550
4551 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4552 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4553 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4554 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4555 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4556 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4557 request along its whole life.
4558
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004559 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4560 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4561 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4562 front of an existing proxy.
4563
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004564 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4565
4566 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4567 http-server-close".
4568
4569
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004570option httpchk
4571option httpchk <uri>
4572option httpchk <method> <uri>
4573option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4574 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4576 yes | no | yes | yes
4577 Arguments :
4578 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4579 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4580 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4581 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4582 ones.
4583
4584 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4585 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4586 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4587
4588 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4589 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4590 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4591 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4592 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4593
4594 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4595 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4596 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4597 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4598 the lack of any response.
4599
4600 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4601
4602 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4603 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4604 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4605
4606 Examples :
4607 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4608 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4609 backend https_relay
4610 mode tcp
4611 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4612 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4613
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004614 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4615 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4616 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004617
4618
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004619option httpclose
4620no option httpclose
4621 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4623 yes | yes | yes | yes
4624 Arguments : none
4625
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004626 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4627 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4628 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4629 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004630 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004631 "option http-tunnel".
4632
4633 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4634 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4635 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4636 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4637 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4638 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4639 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4640 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004641
4642 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004643 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004644 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4645 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4646 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4647 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4648 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004649
4650 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4651 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004652 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4653 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004654 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4655 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004656
4657 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4658 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4659
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004660 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4661 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004662
4663
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004664option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004665 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4667 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004668 Arguments :
4669 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4670 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4671 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4672 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4673 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004674
4675 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4676 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4677 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4678 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4679 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4680 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4681 ports.
4682
4683 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4684
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004685 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4686 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004688 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004689
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004690
4691option http_proxy
4692no option http_proxy
4693 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4695 yes | yes | yes | yes
4696 Arguments : none
4697
4698 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4699 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4700 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4701 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4702 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4703
4704 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4705 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4706 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4707 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004708 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004709 be analyzed.
4710
4711 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4712 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4713
4714 Example :
4715 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4716 backend direct_forward
4717 option httpclose
4718 option http_proxy
4719
4720 See also : "option httpclose"
4721
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004722
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004723option independent-streams
4724no option independent-streams
4725 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4727 yes | yes | yes | yes
4728 Arguments : none
4729
4730 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4731 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4732 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4733 receive data or not.
4734
4735 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4736 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4737 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4738 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4739 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4740 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4741 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4742 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4743 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4744 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4745 socket buffers.
4746
4747 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4748 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4749 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4750 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4751 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4752
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004753 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004754 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4755 deprecated.
4756
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004757 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004758
4759
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004760option ldap-check
4761 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4763 yes | no | yes | yes
4764 Arguments : none
4765
4766 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4767 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4768 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4769 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4770
4771 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4772 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4773
4774 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4775 configure it.
4776
4777 Example :
4778 option ldap-check
4779
4780 See also : "option httpchk"
4781
4782
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004783option external-check
4784 Use external processes for server health checks
4785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4786 yes | no | yes | yes
4787
4788 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4789 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4790 command".
4791
4792 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4793
4794 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4795
4796
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004797option log-health-checks
4798no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004799 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4801 yes | no | yes | yes
4802 Arguments : none
4803
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004804 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4805 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4806 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004807
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004808 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4809 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4810 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4811 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4812 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4813
4814 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4815 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004816
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004817 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4818 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4819 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004820
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004821
4822option log-separate-errors
4823no option log-separate-errors
4824 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4826 yes | yes | yes | no
4827 Arguments : none
4828
4829 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4830 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4831 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4832 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4833 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4834 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4835 provides very important information.
4836
4837 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4838 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4839 error logs.
4840
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004841 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004842 logging.
4843
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004844
4845option logasap
4846no option logasap
4847 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4849 yes | yes | yes | no
4850 Arguments : none
4851
4852 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4853 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4854 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4855 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4856 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4857 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4858 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004859 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004860 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4861 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4862
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004863 Examples :
4864 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4865 mode http
4866 option httplog
4867 option logasap
4868 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4869
4870 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4871 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4872 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4873 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4874
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004875 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004876 logging.
4877
4878
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004879option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004880 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4882 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004883 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004884 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4885 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004886 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004887
4888 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4889 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4890 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4891 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4892 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4893 in the MySQL table, like this :
4894
4895 USE mysql;
4896 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4897 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4898
4899 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4900 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4901 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4902 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4903 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4904 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4905 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4906 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4907 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4908
4909 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4910 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004911
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004912 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004913
4914 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4915 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4916 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4917 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4918 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4919 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4920
4921 See also: "option httpchk"
4922
4923
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004924option nolinger
4925no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004926 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4928 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004929 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004930
4931 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4932 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4933 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4934 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4935 connections.
4936
4937 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4938 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4939 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4940 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4941 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4942 this too.
4943
4944 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4945 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4946 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4947
4948 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4949 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4950 for servers.
4951
4952 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4953 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4954
4955
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004956option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4957 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4959 yes | yes | yes | yes
4960 Arguments :
4961 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4962 matching <network>
4963 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4964 header name.
4965
4966 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4967 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4968 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4969 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4970 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4971 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4972 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4973 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4974 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4975 possible that the client has already brought one.
4976
4977 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4978 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4979 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4980 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4981 header and requires different one.
4982
4983 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4984 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4985 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4986 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4987 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4988 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4989 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4990
4991 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4992 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4993 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4994 both are defined.
4995
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004996 Examples :
4997 # Original Destination address
4998 frontend www
4999 mode http
5000 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5001
5002 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5003 backend www
5004 mode http
5005 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5006
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005007 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5008 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005009
5010
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005011option persist
5012no option persist
5013 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5014 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5015 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005016 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005017
5018 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5019 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5020 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5021 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5022 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5023 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5024 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5025 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5026 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5027 redirected to another valid server.
5028
5029 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5030 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5031
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005032 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005033
5034
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005035option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5036 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5038 yes | no | yes | yes
5039 Arguments :
5040 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5041 PostgreSQL server.
5042
5043 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5044 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5045 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5046 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5047
5048 See also: "option httpchk"
5049
5050
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005051option prefer-last-server
5052no option prefer-last-server
5053 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5054 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5055 yes | no | yes | yes
5056 Arguments : none
5057
5058 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5059 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5060 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5061 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5062 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5063 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5064 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5065 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5066 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005067 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5068 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5069 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5070 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5071 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5072 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5073 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005074
5075 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5076 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5077
5078 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5079
5080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005081option redispatch
5082no option redispatch
5083 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5084 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5085 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005086 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005087
5088 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5089 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5090 be able to access the service anymore.
5091
5092 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5093 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5094
5095 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5096 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5097 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005099 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5100 "redisp" keywords.
5101
5102 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5103 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5104
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005105 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005106
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005107
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005108option redis-check
5109 Use redis health checks for server testing
5110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5111 yes | no | yes | yes
5112 Arguments : none
5113
5114 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5115 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5116 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5117 find the "+PONG" response message.
5118
5119 Example :
5120 option redis-check
5121
5122 See also : "option httpchk"
5123
5124
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005125option smtpchk
5126option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5127 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5129 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005130 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005131 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5132 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5133 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5134
5135 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5136 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5137 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5138
5139 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5140 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5141 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5142 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5143 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5144 dead server.
5145
5146 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5147 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5148 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5149 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5150
5151 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5152 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5153 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5154 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5155 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5156
5157 Example :
5158 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5159
5160 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005162
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005163option socket-stats
5164no option socket-stats
5165
5166 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5168 yes | yes | yes | no
5169
5170 Arguments : none
5171
5172
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005173option splice-auto
5174no option splice-auto
5175 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5177 yes | yes | yes | yes
5178 Arguments : none
5179
5180 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5181 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5182 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5183 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005184 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005185 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5186 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5187 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5188 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5189
5190 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5191 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5192 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5193 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5194 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5195 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5196 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5197 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5198 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5199 keyword.
5200
5201 Example :
5202 option splice-auto
5203
5204 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5205 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5206
5207 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5208 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5209
5210
5211option splice-request
5212no option splice-request
5213 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5215 yes | yes | yes | yes
5216 Arguments : none
5217
5218 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005219 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005220 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5221 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5222 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5223 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5224
5225 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5226
5227 Example :
5228 option splice-request
5229
5230 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5231 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5232
5233 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5234 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5235
5236
5237option splice-response
5238no option splice-response
5239 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5241 yes | yes | yes | yes
5242 Arguments : none
5243
5244 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005245 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005246 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5247 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5248 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5249 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5250
5251 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5252
5253 Example :
5254 option splice-response
5255
5256 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5257 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5258
5259 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5260 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5261
5262
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005263option srvtcpka
5264no option srvtcpka
5265 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5267 yes | no | yes | yes
5268 Arguments : none
5269
5270 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5271 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5272 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5273 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5274
5275 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5276 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5277 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5278 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5279
5280 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5281 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5282 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5283 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5284 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5285
5286 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5287
5288 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5289 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5290 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5291
5292 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5293 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5294
5295 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5296
5297
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005298option ssl-hello-chk
5299 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5301 yes | no | yes | yes
5302 Arguments : none
5303
5304 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5305 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5306 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5307 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5308 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5309 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5310 hello message.
5311
5312 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5313 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5314 messages, which is appreciable.
5315
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005316 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5317 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5318 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005319
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005320 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5321
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005322
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005323option tcp-check
5324 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5325 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5326 yes | no | yes | yes
5327
5328 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5329 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5330
5331 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5332 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5333 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5334
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005335 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005336 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5337 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5338 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5339 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5340 only.
5341
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005342 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005343 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5344 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5345 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5346 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5347
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005348 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005349 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5350 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005351 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005352 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5353 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5354 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5355 the respective protocols.
5356 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5357 analysed.
5358
5359 Examples :
5360 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5361 option tcp-check
5362 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5363
5364 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5365 option tcp-check
5366 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5367
5368 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5369 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005370 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005371 option tcp-check
5372 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5373 tcp-check expect +PONG
5374 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5375 tcp-check expect string role:master
5376 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5377 tcp-check expect string +OK
5378
5379 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5380 (send many headers before analyzing)
5381 option tcp-check
5382 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5383 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5384 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5385 tcp-check send \r\n
5386 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5387
5388
5389 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5390
5391
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005392option tcp-smart-accept
5393no option tcp-smart-accept
5394 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5396 yes | yes | yes | no
5397 Arguments : none
5398
5399 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5400 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5401 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5402 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5403 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5404 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5405
5406 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5407 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5408 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5409 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5410
5411 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5412 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5413 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5414 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5415
5416 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5417 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5418 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5419
5420 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5421 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5422 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5423
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005424 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5425
5426
5427option tcp-smart-connect
5428no option tcp-smart-connect
5429 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5431 yes | no | yes | yes
5432 Arguments : none
5433
5434 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5435 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5436 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5437 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5438 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5439
5440 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5441 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5442 complex.
5443
5444 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5445 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5446 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5447
5448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5450
5451 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5452
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005453
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005454option tcpka
5455 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5457 yes | yes | yes | yes
5458 Arguments : none
5459
5460 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5461 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5462 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5463 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5464
5465 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5466 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5467 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5468 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5469
5470 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5471 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5472 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5473 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5474 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5475
5476 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5477
5478 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5479 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5480 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5481 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5482 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5483 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5484 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5485 backends.
5486
5487 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5488
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005489
5490option tcplog
5491 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5493 yes | yes | yes | yes
5494 Arguments : none
5495
5496 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5497 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5498 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5499 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5500 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5501 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5502 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5503 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5504
5505 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005507 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005508
5509
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005510option transparent
5511no option transparent
5512 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005514 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005515 Arguments : none
5516
5517 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5518 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5519 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5520 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5521 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5522 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5523 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5524 appropriate server.
5525
5526 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5527 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5528
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005529 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005530 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005531
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005532
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005533external-check command <command>
5534 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5536 yes | no | yes | yes
5537
5538 Arguments :
5539 <command> is the external command to run
5540
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005541 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5542
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005543 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005544
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005545 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5546 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5547 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5548 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5549 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5550 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005551
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005552 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5553
5554 Environment variables :
5555 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5556 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5557
5558 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5559
5560 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5561
5562 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5563 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5564 for a UNIX socket).
5565
5566 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5567
5568 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5569
5570 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5571
5572 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5573
5574 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5575
5576 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5577 socket).
5578
5579 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5580 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5581
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005582 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5583 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5584 failed.
5585
5586 Example :
5587 external-check command /bin/true
5588
5589 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5590
5591
5592external-check path <path>
5593 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5595 yes | no | yes | yes
5596
5597 Arguments :
5598 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5599
5600 The default path is "".
5601
5602 Example :
5603 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5604
5605 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5606 "external-check command"
5607
5608
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005609persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005610persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005611 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5613 yes | no | yes | yes
5614 Arguments :
5615 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005616 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5617 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005618
5619 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5620 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5621 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5622 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5623 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5624 forwarded to this server.
5625
5626 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5627 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5628 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005629 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005630 a single "listen" section.
5631
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005632 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5633 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5634 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5635
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005636 Example :
5637 listen tse-farm
5638 bind :3389
5639 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5640 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5641 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5642 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5643 persist rdp-cookie
5644 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005645 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005646 balance rdp-cookie
5647 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5648 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5649
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005650 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5651 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005652
5653
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005654rate-limit sessions <rate>
5655 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5657 yes | yes | yes | no
5658 Arguments :
5659 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5660 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5661
5662 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5663 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5664 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5665 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5666 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5667 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5668
5669 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5670 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5671 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5672 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5673
5674 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5675 listen smtp
5676 mode tcp
5677 bind :25
5678 rate-limit sessions 10
5679 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5680
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005681 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5682 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5683 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005684
5685 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5686
5687
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005688redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5689redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5690redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005691 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5693 no | yes | yes | yes
5694
5695 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005696 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005697
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005698 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005699 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005700 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5701 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5702 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005703
5704 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5705 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5706 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5707 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5708 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005709 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5710 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5711 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5712 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005713
5714 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5715 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5716 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5717 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5718 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5719 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005720 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005721 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005722 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5723 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5724 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005725
5726 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005727 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5728 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5729 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5730 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5731 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5732 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5733 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5734 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005735
5736 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5737 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5738
5739 - "drop-query"
5740 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5741 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5742 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5743 with a location-type redirect.
5744
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005745 - "append-slash"
5746 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5747 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5748 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5749 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5750
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005751 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5752 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5753 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5754 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5755 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5756 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5757 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5758
5759 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5760 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5761 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5762 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5763 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5764 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5765 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005766
5767 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5768 acl clear dst_port 80
5769 acl secure dst_port 8080
5770 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005771 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005772 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005773 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5774
5775 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005776 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5777 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5778 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005779 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005780
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005781 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5782 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5783 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5784
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005785 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005786 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005787
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005788 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5789 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5790 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005792 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005793
5794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005795redisp (deprecated)
5796redispatch (deprecated)
5797 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5798 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5799 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005800 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005801
5802 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5803 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5804 be able to access the service anymore.
5805
5806 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5807 redistribute them to a working server.
5808
5809 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5810 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5811 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005812
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005813 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5814 "option redispatch" instead.
5815
5816 See also : "option redispatch"
5817
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005818
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005819reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005820 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5822 no | yes | yes | yes
5823 Arguments :
5824 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5825 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005826 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005827
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005828 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5829 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5830
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005831 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5832 the last header of an HTTP request.
5833
5834 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5835 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5836 responses.
5837
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005838 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5839 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5840 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5841
5842 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5843 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005844
5845
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005846reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5847reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005848 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5850 no | yes | yes | yes
5851 Arguments :
5852 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5853 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5854 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5855 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5856 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5857 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5858 ignores case.
5859
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005860 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5861 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5862
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005863 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5864 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5865 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5866 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005867 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005868
5869 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5870 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5871
5872 Example :
5873 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5874 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5875 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5876
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005877 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5878 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005879
5880
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005881reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5882reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005883 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5885 no | yes | yes | yes
5886 Arguments :
5887 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5888 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5889 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5890 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5891 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5892 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5893
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005894 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5895 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5896
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005897 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5898 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5899 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5900 next servers.
5901
5902 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5903 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5904 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5905
5906 Example :
5907 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5908 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5909 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5910
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005911 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5912 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005913
5914
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005915reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5916reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005917 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5919 no | yes | yes | yes
5920 Arguments :
5921 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5922 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5923 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5924 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5925 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5926 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5927 case.
5928
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005929 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5930 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5931
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005932 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5933 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5934 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5935 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005936 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005937
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005938 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005939 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005940 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005941
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005942 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5943 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5944
5945 Example :
5946 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5947 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5948 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5949
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005950 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5951 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005952
5953
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005954reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5955reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005956 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5958 no | yes | yes | yes
5959 Arguments :
5960 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5961 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5962 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5963 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5964 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5965 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5966 case.
5967
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005968 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5969 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5970
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005971 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5972 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5973 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5974 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5975
5976 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5977 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5978
5979 Example :
5980 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5981 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5982 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5983 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5984
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005985 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5986 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005987
5988
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005989reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5990reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005991 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5993 no | yes | yes | yes
5994 Arguments :
5995 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5996 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5997 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5998 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5999 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6000 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6001
6002 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6003 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6004 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6005 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006006 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006007
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006008 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6009 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6010
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006011 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6012 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6013 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6014
6015 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6016 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6017 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6018 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6019 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6020
6021 Example :
6022 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006023 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006024 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6025 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6026
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006027 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6028 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006029
6030
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006031reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6032reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006033 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6035 no | yes | yes | yes
6036 Arguments :
6037 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6038 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6039 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6040 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6041 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6042 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6043 ignores case.
6044
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006045 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6046 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6047
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006048 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6049 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006050 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6051 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6052 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006053 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6054 not set.
6055
6056 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6057 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6058 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6059 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6060 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6061
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006062 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006063 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6064 # block all others.
6065 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6066 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6067
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006068 # block bad guys
6069 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6070 reqitarpit . if badguys
6071
6072 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6073 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006074
6075
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006076retries <value>
6077 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6079 yes | no | yes | yes
6080 Arguments :
6081 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6082 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6083 default value is 3.
6084
6085 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6086 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6087 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6088
6089 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
6090 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
6091
6092 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6093 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6094
6095 See also : "option redispatch"
6096
6097
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006098rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006099 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6101 no | yes | yes | yes
6102 Arguments :
6103 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6104 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006105 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006106
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006107 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6108 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6109
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006110 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6111 the last header of an HTTP response.
6112
6113 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6114 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6115 responses.
6116
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006117 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6118 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006119
6120
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006121rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6122rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006123 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6125 no | yes | yes | yes
6126 Arguments :
6127 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6128 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6129 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6130 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6131 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6132 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6133 ignores case.
6134
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006135 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6136 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6137
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006138 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6139 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006140 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006141 client.
6142
6143 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6144 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6145 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6146
6147 Example :
6148 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006149 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006150
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006151 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6152 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006153
6154
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006155rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6156rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006157 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6159 no | yes | yes | yes
6160 Arguments :
6161 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6162 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6163 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6164 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6165 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6166 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6167 ignores case.
6168
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006169 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6170 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6171
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006172 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6173 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6174 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6175 case-sensitive.
6176
6177 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006178 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6179 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6180 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006181
6182 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6183 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6184
6185 Example :
6186 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6187 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6188
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006189 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6190 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006191
6192
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006193rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6194rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006195 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6197 no | yes | yes | yes
6198 Arguments :
6199 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6200 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6201 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6202 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6203 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6204 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6205 ignores case.
6206
6207 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6208 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6209 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6210 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006211 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006212
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006213 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6214 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6215
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006216 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6217 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6218 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6219
6220 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6221 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6222 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6223 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6224 are not case-sensitive.
6225
6226 Example :
6227 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6228 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6229
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006230 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6231 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006232
6233
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006234server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006235 Declare a server in a backend
6236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6237 no | no | yes | yes
6238 Arguments :
6239 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006240 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006241 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006242
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006243 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6244 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6245 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6246 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006247 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6248 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6249 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6250 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6251 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006252 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6253 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6254 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6255 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6256 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6257 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6258 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006259 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006260 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6261 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6262 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6263 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006264
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006265 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006266 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6267 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6268 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6269 adding this value to the client's port.
6270
6271 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6272 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006273 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006274
6275 Examples :
6276 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6277 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006278 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006279 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6280 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6281 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006282
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006283 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6284 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006285
6286
6287source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006288source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006289source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006290 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6292 yes | no | yes | yes
6293 Arguments :
6294 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6295 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006296
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006297 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006298 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6299 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6300 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6301 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6302 supported prefixes are :
6303 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6304 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6305 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006306 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006307 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6308 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6309 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6310 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006311
6312 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6313 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006314 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6315 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6316 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006317
6318 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6319 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6320 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6321 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6322 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6323 <addr>.
6324
6325 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6326 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6327 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6328 port.
6329
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006330 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6331 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6332 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6333 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006334 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006335 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6336 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6337 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6338 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6339 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6340 HTTP header.
6341
6342 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6343 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006344 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006345 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6346 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6347 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6348 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6349 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6350 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6351 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6352
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006353 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6354 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6355 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6356 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6357 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6358 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6359
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006360 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6361 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6362 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6363 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6364
6365 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6366 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6367 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6368 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6369 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6370 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6371
6372 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6373 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6374 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6375 there are two methods :
6376
6377 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6378 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6379 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6380 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6381 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6382 of the client ranges may be used.
6383
6384 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6385 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6386 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6387 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6388 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6389 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6390 same session.
6391
6392 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6393 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6394 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6395 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6396 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6397 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6398
6399 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6400 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6401 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006402 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006403
6404 Examples :
6405 backend private
6406 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6407 source 192.168.1.200
6408
6409 backend transparent_ssl1
6410 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6411 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6412
6413 backend transparent_ssl2
6414 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6415 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6416 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6417
6418 backend transparent_ssl3
6419 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6420 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6421 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6422
6423 backend transparent_smtp
6424 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6425 # with Tproxy version 4.
6426 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6427
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006428 backend transparent_http
6429 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6430 # proxy.
6431 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006433 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006434 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006436
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006437srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6438 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6440 yes | no | yes | yes
6441 Arguments :
6442 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6443 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6444 as explained at the top of this document.
6445
6446 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6447 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6448 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6449 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6450 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6451 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6452 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6453
6454 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6455 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6456 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6457 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6458 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006459 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006460 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006461 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006462
6463 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6464 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6465 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6466 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6467 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6468 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6469
6470 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6471 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6472
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006473 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6474 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006475
6476
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006477stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6478 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006480 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006481
6482 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6483 matched.
6484
6485 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6486 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6487
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006488 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6489 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6490 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6491
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006492 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6493 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6494 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6495 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006496
6497 Example :
6498 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6499 backend stats_localhost
6500 stats enable
6501 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6502
6503 Example :
6504 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6505 backend stats_auth
6506 stats enable
6507 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6508 stats admin if TRUE
6509
6510 Example :
6511 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6512 userlist stats-auth
6513 group admin users admin
6514 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6515 group readonly users haproxy
6516 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6517
6518 backend stats_auth
6519 stats enable
6520 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6521 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6522 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6523 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6524
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006525 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6526 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6527 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006528
6529
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006530stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6531 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006533 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006534 Arguments :
6535 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6536
6537 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6538
6539 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6540 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6541 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6542 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6543 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6544 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6545
6546 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6547 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6548 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006549 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006550
6551 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6552 report using "stats scope".
6553
6554 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6555 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6556 unobvious parameters.
6557
6558 Example :
6559 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6560 backend public_www
6561 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6562 stats enable
6563 stats hide-version
6564 stats scope .
6565 stats uri /admin?stats
6566 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6567 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6568 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6569
6570 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6571 backend private_monitoring
6572 stats enable
6573 stats uri /admin?stats
6574 stats refresh 5s
6575
6576 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6577
6578
6579stats enable
6580 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006582 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006583 Arguments : none
6584
6585 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6586 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6587 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6588 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6589 - stats auth : no authentication
6590 - stats scope : no restriction
6591
6592 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6593 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6594 unobvious parameters.
6595
6596 Example :
6597 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6598 backend public_www
6599 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6600 stats enable
6601 stats hide-version
6602 stats scope .
6603 stats uri /admin?stats
6604 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6605 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6606 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6607
6608 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6609 backend private_monitoring
6610 stats enable
6611 stats uri /admin?stats
6612 stats refresh 5s
6613
6614 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6615
6616
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006617stats hide-version
6618 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006620 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006621 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006622
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006623 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6624 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6625 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6626 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6627 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6628 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006630 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6631 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6632 unobvious parameters.
6633
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006634 Example :
6635 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6636 backend public_www
6637 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006638 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006639 stats hide-version
6640 stats scope .
6641 stats uri /admin?stats
6642 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6643 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6644 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006645
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006646 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6647 backend private_monitoring
6648 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006649 stats uri /admin?stats
6650 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006651
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006652 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006653
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006654
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006655stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6656 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6657 Access control for statistics
6658
6659 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6660 no | no | yes | yes
6661
6662 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6663 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6664 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6665 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6666 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6667 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6668
6669 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6670 instance.
6671
6672 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6673 about ACL usage.
6674
6675
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006676stats realm <realm>
6677 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006679 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006680 Arguments :
6681 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6682 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6683 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6684
6685 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6686 using a backslash ('\').
6687
6688 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6689 only related to authentication.
6690
6691 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6692 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6693 unobvious parameters.
6694
6695 Example :
6696 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6697 backend public_www
6698 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6699 stats enable
6700 stats hide-version
6701 stats scope .
6702 stats uri /admin?stats
6703 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6704 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6705 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6706
6707 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6708 backend private_monitoring
6709 stats enable
6710 stats uri /admin?stats
6711 stats refresh 5s
6712
6713 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6714
6715
6716stats refresh <delay>
6717 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006719 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006720 Arguments :
6721 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6722 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6723 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6724 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6725 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6726 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6727
6728 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6729 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6730 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6731 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6732
6733 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6734 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6735 unobvious parameters.
6736
6737 Example :
6738 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6739 backend public_www
6740 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6741 stats enable
6742 stats hide-version
6743 stats scope .
6744 stats uri /admin?stats
6745 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6746 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6747 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6748
6749 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6750 backend private_monitoring
6751 stats enable
6752 stats uri /admin?stats
6753 stats refresh 5s
6754
6755 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6756
6757
6758stats scope { <name> | "." }
6759 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006761 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006762 Arguments :
6763 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6764 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6765 section in which the statement appears.
6766
6767 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6768 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6769 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6770 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6771 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6772 exists.
6773
6774 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6775 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6776 unobvious parameters.
6777
6778 Example :
6779 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6780 backend public_www
6781 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6782 stats enable
6783 stats hide-version
6784 stats scope .
6785 stats uri /admin?stats
6786 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6787 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6788 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6789
6790 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6791 backend private_monitoring
6792 stats enable
6793 stats uri /admin?stats
6794 stats refresh 5s
6795
6796 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6797
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006798
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006799stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006800 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006802 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006803
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006804 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006805 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6806
6807 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6808 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6809
6810 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6811 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006812 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006813
6814 Example :
6815 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6816 backend private_monitoring
6817 stats enable
6818 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6819 stats uri /admin?stats
6820 stats refresh 5s
6821
6822 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6823 global section.
6824
6825
6826stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006827 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6829 yes | yes | yes | yes
6830 Arguments : none
6831
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006832 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006833 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6834 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6835 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6836 - IP (socket, server)
6837 - cookie (backend, server)
6838
6839 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6840 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006841 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006842
6843 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6844
6845
6846stats show-node [ <name> ]
6847 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006849 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006850 Arguments:
6851 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6852 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6853
6854 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6855 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006856 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006857
6858 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6859 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6860 unobvious parameters.
6861
6862 Example:
6863 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6864 backend private_monitoring
6865 stats enable
6866 stats show-node Europe-1
6867 stats uri /admin?stats
6868 stats refresh 5s
6869
6870 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6871 section.
6872
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006873
6874stats uri <prefix>
6875 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006877 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006878 Arguments :
6879 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6880 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6881 query string.
6882
6883 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6884 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6885 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6886 possible to reach it in the application.
6887
6888 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006889 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006890 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6891 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6892 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6893 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6894
6895 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6896 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6897 an address or a port to statistics only.
6898
6899 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6900 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6901 unobvious parameters.
6902
6903 Example :
6904 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6905 backend public_www
6906 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6907 stats enable
6908 stats hide-version
6909 stats scope .
6910 stats uri /admin?stats
6911 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6912 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6913 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6914
6915 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6916 backend private_monitoring
6917 stats enable
6918 stats uri /admin?stats
6919 stats refresh 5s
6920
6921 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6922
6923
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006924stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6925 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006927 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006928
6929 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006930 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006931 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6932 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6933 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6934
6935 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6936 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6937 the "stick-table" statement.
6938
6939 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6940 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6941 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6942 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6943 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6944
6945 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6946 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6947 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6948 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6949 transformation rules.
6950
6951 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6952 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6953 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6954 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6955 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6956 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6957 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6958
6959 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6960 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6961 ACL based conditions.
6962
6963 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6964 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6965 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6966 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6967
6968 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6969 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6970 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6971 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6972
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006973 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6974 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6975 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6976
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006977 Example :
6978 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6979 # last 30 minutes
6980 backend pop
6981 mode tcp
6982 balance roundrobin
6983 stick store-request src
6984 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6985 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6986 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6987
6988 backend smtp
6989 mode tcp
6990 balance roundrobin
6991 stick match src table pop
6992 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6993 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6994
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006995 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006996 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006997
6998
6999stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7000 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7002 no | no | yes | yes
7003
7004 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7005 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7006 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7007 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7008
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007009 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7010 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7011 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7012
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007013 Examples :
7014 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007015 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007016
7017 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7018 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7019 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7020
7021
7022 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7023 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7024 backend http
7025 mode http
7026 balance roundrobin
7027 stick on src table https
7028 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7029 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7030 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7031
7032 backend https
7033 mode tcp
7034 balance roundrobin
7035 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7036 stick on src
7037 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7038 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7039
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007040 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007041
7042
7043stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7044 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7046 no | no | yes | yes
7047
7048 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007049 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007050 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7051 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7052 server is selected.
7053
7054 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7055 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7056 the "stick-table" statement.
7057
7058 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7059 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7060 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7061 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7062 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7063 address.
7064
7065 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7066 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7067 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7068 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7069 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7070 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7071 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7072 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7073 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7074 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7075
7076 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7077 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7078 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7079 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7080 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7081 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7082 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7083
7084 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7085 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7086 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7087 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7088
7089 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7090 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7091 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7092 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7093 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7094 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007095 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7096 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7097 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7098 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7099 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7100 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007101
7102 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7103 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7104 the request.
7105
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007106 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7107 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7108 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7109
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007110 Example :
7111 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7112 # last 30 minutes
7113 backend pop
7114 mode tcp
7115 balance roundrobin
7116 stick store-request src
7117 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7118 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7119 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7120
7121 backend smtp
7122 mode tcp
7123 balance roundrobin
7124 stick match src table pop
7125 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7126 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7127
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007128 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007129 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007130
7131
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007132stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007133 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7134 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007135 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007137 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007138
7139 Arguments :
7140 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7141 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7142 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7143 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7144
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007145 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7146 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7147 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7148 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7149
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007150 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7151 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7152 instance.
7153
7154 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7155 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7156 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7157 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7158 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7159 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007160 to 32 characters.
7161
7162 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7163 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7164 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007165 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007166 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7167 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007168
7169 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007170 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7171 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007172 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7173 increase.
7174
7175 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007176 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7177 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7178 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007179
7180 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7181 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7182 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7183 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7184 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7185 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7186 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7187 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7188 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7189 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7190 parameter (see below).
7191
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007192 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7193 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7194 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7195 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7196 soft restart.
7197
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007198 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
7199
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007200 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7201 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7202 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7203 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7204 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007205 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007206 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7207 if not expiration delay is specified.
7208
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007209 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7210 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7211 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7212 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007213 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7214 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7215 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7216 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7217 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7218 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7219 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7220 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7221 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7222 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7223 types and their arguments.
7224
7225 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7226 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7227 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7228 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7229
7230 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7231 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7232 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7233 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7234
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007235 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7236 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7237 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7238 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7239 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7240 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7241
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007242 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7243 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7244 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7245 they were received.
7246
7247 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7248 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7249 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7250 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7251 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7252
7253 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7254 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7255 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7256 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7257 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7258
7259 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7260 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7261 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7262
7263 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7264 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7265 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7266 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7267 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7268
7269 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7270 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7271 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7272 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7273 the client side.
7274
7275 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7276 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7277 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7278 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7279 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7280 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7281 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7282
7283 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7284 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7285 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7286 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7287 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7288 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7289 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7290
7291 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7292 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7293 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7294 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7295 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7296 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7297
7298 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7299 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7300 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7301 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7302
7303 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7304 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7305 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7306 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7307 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7308 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7309 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7310 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7311 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7312 recommended for better fairness.
7313
7314 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7315 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7316 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7317 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7318
7319 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7320 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7321 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7322 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7323 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7324 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7325 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7326 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7327 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7328 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007329
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007330 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7331 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007332 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7333 reference it.
7334
7335 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7336 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7337 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7338 as an exclusive stickiness.
7339
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007340 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7341 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7342 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7343 something that can be ignored.
7344
7345 Example:
7346 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7347 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7348 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7349 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7350
7351 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007352 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007353
7354
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007355stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7356 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7358 no | no | yes | yes
7359
7360 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007361 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007362 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7363 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7364 server is selected.
7365
7366 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7367 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7368 the "stick-table" statement.
7369
7370 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7371 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7372 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7373 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7374
7375 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7376 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7377 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7378 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7379 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7380 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007381 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007382 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7383 rules.
7384
7385 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7386 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7387 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7388 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7389 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7390 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7391 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7392
7393 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7394 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7395 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7396 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7397
7398 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7399 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7400 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7401 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7402 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7403 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007404 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7405 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7406 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7407 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7408 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7409 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7410 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7411 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7412 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007413
7414 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7415
7416 Example :
7417 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7418 backend https
7419 mode tcp
7420 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007421 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007422 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007423
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007424 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7425 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7426
7427 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7428 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7429 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7430
7431 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7432 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007433
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007434 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7435 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7436 # at offset 44.
7437
7438 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7439 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7440
7441 # Learn on response if server hello.
7442 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007443
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007444 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7445 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7446
7447 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7448 extraction.
7449
7450
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007451tcp-check connect [params*]
7452 Opens a new connection
7453 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7454 no | no | yes | yes
7455
7456 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7457 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7458 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7459
7460 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7461 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7462 of the sequence.
7463
7464 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7465 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7466 do.
7467
7468 Parameters :
7469 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7470 use the TCP connection.
7471
7472 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7473 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7474 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7475
7476 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7477
7478 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7479
7480 Examples:
7481 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7482 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7483 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7484 option tcp-check
7485 tcp-check connect
7486 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7487 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7488 tcp-check send \r\n
7489 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7490 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7491 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7492 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7493 tcp-check send \r\n
7494 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7495 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7496
7497 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7498 option tcp-check
7499 tcp-check connect port 110
7500 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7501 tcp-check connect port 143
7502 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7503 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7504
7505 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7506
7507
7508tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7509 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7510 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7511 no | no | yes | yes
7512
7513 Arguments :
7514 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7515 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7516 binary.
7517 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7518 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7519 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7520
7521 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7522 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7523 with the usual backslash ('\').
7524 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7525 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7526 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7527 used upper or lower case.
7528
7529
7530 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7531
7532 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7533 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7534 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7535 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7536 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7537 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7538 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7539 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7540
7541 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7542 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7543 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7544 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7545 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7546 expression.
7547
7548 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7549 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7550 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7551 this exact hexadecimal string.
7552 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7553
7554 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7555 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7556 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7557 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7558 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7559 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7560 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7561 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7562 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7563 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7564 the null character.
7565
7566 Examples :
7567 # perform a POP check
7568 option tcp-check
7569 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7570
7571 # perform an IMAP check
7572 option tcp-check
7573 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7574
7575 # look for the redis master server
7576 option tcp-check
7577 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7578 tcp-check expect +PONG
7579 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7580 tcp-check expect string role:master
7581 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7582 tcp-check expect string +OK
7583
7584
7585 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7586 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7587
7588
7589tcp-check send <data>
7590 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7591 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7592 no | no | yes | yes
7593
7594 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7595 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7596
7597 Examples :
7598 # look for the redis master server
7599 option tcp-check
7600 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7601 tcp-check expect string role:master
7602
7603 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7604 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7605
7606
7607tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7608 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7609 tcp health check
7610 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7611 no | no | yes | yes
7612
7613 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7614 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7615 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7616 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7617 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7618 hexadecimal string.
7619 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7620
7621 Examples :
7622 # redis check in binary
7623 option tcp-check
7624 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7625 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7626
7627
7628 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7629 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7630
7631
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007632tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7633 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7635 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007636 Arguments :
7637 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007638 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7639 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007640
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007641 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007642
7643 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7644 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007645 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7646 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7647 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7648 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7649 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7650 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007651
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007652 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7653 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7654 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7655 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007656
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007657 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007658 - accept :
7659 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7660 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7661 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007662
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007663 - reject :
7664 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7665 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7666 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7667 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7668 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7669 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7670 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7671 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7672 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7673 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7674 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7675 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007676
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007677 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7678 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7679 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7680 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7681 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7682 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7683 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7684 hosts.
7685
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007686 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7687 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7688 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7689 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7690 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7691 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7692 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7693 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7694 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7695 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7696 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7697
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007698 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007699 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007700 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007701 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007702 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7703 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007704 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007705 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7706 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7707 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7708 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7709 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007710
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007711 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007712 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007713 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007714 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7715 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7716 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7717 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007718
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007719 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7720 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7721 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7722 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007723
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007724 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7725 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7726 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7727 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7728 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007729 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7730 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7731 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7732 layer7 information is extracted.
7733
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007734 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7735 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7736 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7737 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7738 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007739
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007740 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7741 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7742 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007743
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007744 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7745 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7746 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007747
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007748 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007749 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007750 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007751
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007752 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7753 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7754 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007755
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007756 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007757 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7758 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007759
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007760 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7761
7762 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7763
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007764 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7765
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007766 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007767
7768
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007769tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7770 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007772 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007773 Arguments :
7774 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007775 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007776 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7777 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007778
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007779 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007780
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007781 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7782 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7783 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7784 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7785 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007786
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007787 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7788 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7789 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7790 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007791 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7792 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7793 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7794 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7795 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7796 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007797 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007798 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007799
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007800 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7801 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7802 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7803 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007804
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007805 Four types of actions are supported :
7806 - accept : the request is accepted
7807 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7808 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007809 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007810
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007811 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7812 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007813
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007814 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7815 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7816 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7817 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7818 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7819 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007820
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007821 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007822 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7823 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007824
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007825 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007826 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7827 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7828 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7829 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007830 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7831 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7832 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007833
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007834 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007835 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7836 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7837 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007838
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007839 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007840 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7841 # and reject everything else.
7842 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7843 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007844 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007845 tcp-request content reject
7846
7847 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007848 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7849 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7850 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007851 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007852
7853 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7854 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7855 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007856 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007857 tcp-request content reject
7858
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007859 Example:
7860 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7861 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007862 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007863
7864 Example:
7865 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7866 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007867 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007868
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007869 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7870 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7871
7872 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007873 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007874 # protecting all our sites
7875 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007876 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7877 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007878 ...
7879 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7880
7881 backend http_dynamic
7882 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007883 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007884 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007885 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7886 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7887 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007888 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007890 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007891
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007892 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007893
7894
7895tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7896 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007898 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007899 Arguments :
7900 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7901 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7902 as explained at the top of this document.
7903
7904 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7905 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7906 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7907 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7908 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7909
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007910 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7911 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7912 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7913 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7914
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007915 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7916 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007917 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007918 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007919 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7920 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7921 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7922 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007923
7924 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7925 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7926 it pass through unaffected.
7927
7928 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7929 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7930 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007931 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007932 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7933 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007934 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7935 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7936 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007937
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007938 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007939 "timeout client".
7940
7941
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007942tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7943 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7945 no | no | yes | yes
7946 Arguments :
7947 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007948 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007949
7950 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7951
7952 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7953 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7954 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007955 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7956 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007957
7958 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7959
7960 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7961 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7962 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7963 inserted.
7964
7965 Two types of actions are supported :
7966 - accept :
7967 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7968 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7969 the rules evaluation.
7970
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007971 - close :
7972 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7973 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7974 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7975 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7976 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7977 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007978 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007979 protocols.
7980
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007981 - reject :
7982 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7983 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007984 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007985
7986 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7987 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7988 for changing the default action to a reject.
7989
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007990 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7991 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7992 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7993 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007994 period.
7995
7996 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7997
7998 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7999
8000
8001tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8002 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8004 no | no | yes | yes
8005 Arguments :
8006 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8007 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8008 as explained at the top of this document.
8009
8010 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8011
8012
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008013timeout check <timeout>
8014 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8015 established.
8016
8017 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8018 yes | no | yes | yes
8019 Arguments:
8020 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8021 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8022 as explained at the top of this document.
8023
8024 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8025 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8026 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8027 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008028 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8029 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8030 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008031
8032 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8033 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8034
8035 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8036 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008037 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008038
8039 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8040 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8041 forget about it.
8042
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008043 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8044 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008045
8046
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008047timeout client <timeout>
8048timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8049 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8051 yes | yes | yes | no
8052 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008053 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008054 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8055 as explained at the top of this document.
8056
8057 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8058 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8059 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8060 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8061 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8062 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8063 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8064 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008065 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008066 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008067 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8068 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008069 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8070 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008071
8072 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8073 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8074 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8075 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8076 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8077 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8078
8079 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8080 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8081 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8082
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008083 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008084
8085
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008086timeout client-fin <timeout>
8087 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8089 yes | yes | yes | no
8090 Arguments :
8091 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8092 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8093 as explained at the top of this document.
8094
8095 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8096 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8097 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8098 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8099 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8100 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8101 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8102 down in one direction.
8103
8104 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8105 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8106 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8107
8108 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8109
8110
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008111timeout connect <timeout>
8112timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8113 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8115 yes | no | yes | yes
8116 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008117 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008118 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8119 as explained at the top of this document.
8120
8121 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008122 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008123 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008124 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008125 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8126 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008127
8128 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8129 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8130 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8131 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8132 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8133 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8134
8135 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8136 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8137 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8138
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008139 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8140 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008141
8142
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008143timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8144 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8146 yes | yes | yes | yes
8147 Arguments :
8148 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8149 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8150 as explained at the top of this document.
8151
8152 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8153 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8154 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8155 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8156 once the request has started to present itself.
8157
8158 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8159 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8160 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8161 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8162 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8163
8164 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8165 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8166 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8167 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8168
8169 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8170 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8171 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8172 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8173 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008174 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008175
8176 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8177 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8178 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8179 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8180
8181 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8182
8183
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008184timeout http-request <timeout>
8185 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008187 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008188 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008189 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008190 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8191 as explained at the top of this document.
8192
8193 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8194 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8195 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8196 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8197 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8198 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8199 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008200 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8201 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8202 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8203 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8204 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
8205 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
8206 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008207
8208 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8209 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008210 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8211 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008212
8213 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8214 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8215 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8216 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8217 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8218
8219 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008220 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8221 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8222 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008223
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008224 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008225
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008226
8227timeout queue <timeout>
8228 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8230 yes | no | yes | yes
8231 Arguments :
8232 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8233 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8234 as explained at the top of this document.
8235
8236 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8237 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8238 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8239 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8240 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8241
8242 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8243 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8244 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8245 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8246
8247 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8248
8249
8250timeout server <timeout>
8251timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8252 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8254 yes | no | yes | yes
8255 Arguments :
8256 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8257 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8258 as explained at the top of this document.
8259
8260 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8261 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8262 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8263 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8264 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8265 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8266 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8267
8268 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8269 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8270 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8271 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8272 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008273 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008274 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008275 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8276 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8277 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8278 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008279
8280 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8281 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8282 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8283 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8284 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8285 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8286
8287 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8288 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8289 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8290
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008291 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008292
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008293
8294timeout server-fin <timeout>
8295 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8297 yes | no | yes | yes
8298 Arguments :
8299 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8300 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8301 as explained at the top of this document.
8302
8303 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8304 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8305 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8306 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8307 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8308 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8309 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8310 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8311 situations, it should not be needed.
8312
8313 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8314 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8315 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8316
8317 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8318
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008319
8320timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008321 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8323 yes | yes | yes | yes
8324 Arguments :
8325 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8326 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8327 as explained at the top of this document.
8328
8329 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8330 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8331 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8332
8333 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8334 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8335 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8336 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008337 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008338
8339 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8340
8341
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008342timeout tunnel <timeout>
8343 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8345 yes | no | yes | yes
8346 Arguments :
8347 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8348 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8349 as explained at the top of this document.
8350
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008351 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008352 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8353 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8354 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8355 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8356 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8357 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8358 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8359 specified.
8360
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008361 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8362 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8363 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8364 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8365 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8366 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8367 state.
8368
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008369 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8370 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8371 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8372 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8373 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8374
8375 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8376 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8377 forget about it.
8378
8379 Example :
8380 defaults http
8381 option http-server-close
8382 timeout connect 5s
8383 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008384 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008385 timeout server 30s
8386 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8387
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008388 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008389
8390
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008391transparent (deprecated)
8392 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008394 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008395 Arguments : none
8396
8397 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8398 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8399 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8400 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8401 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8402 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8403 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8404 appropriate server.
8405
8406 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8407
8408 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8409 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8410
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008411 See also: "option transparent"
8412
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008413unique-id-format <string>
8414 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8416 yes | yes | yes | no
8417 Arguments :
8418 <string> is a log-format string.
8419
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008420 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8421 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8422 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8423 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008424
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008425 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8426 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8427 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8428 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8429 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8430 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8431 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8432 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008433
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008434 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8435 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008436
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008437 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008438
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008439 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008440
8441 will generate:
8442
8443 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8444
8445 See also: "unique-id-header"
8446
8447unique-id-header <name>
8448 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8450 yes | yes | yes | no
8451 Arguments :
8452 <name> is the name of the header.
8453
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008454 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8455 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008456
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008457 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008458
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008459 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008460 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8461
8462 will generate:
8463
8464 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8465
8466 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008467
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008468use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008469 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8471 no | yes | yes | no
8472 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008473 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8474 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008475
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008476 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8477 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008478
8479 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8480 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8481 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008482 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8483 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8484 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8485 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008486
8487 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8488 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8489 assign the backend.
8490
8491 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8492 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8493 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8494 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8495 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8496 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8497
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008498 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008499 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008500 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8501 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8502 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8503
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008504 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8505 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8506 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8507 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8508 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8509 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8510 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8511 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8512 cannot be forced from the request.
8513
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008514 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008515 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8516 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8517
8518 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8519 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008520
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008521
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008522use-server <server> if <condition>
8523use-server <server> unless <condition>
8524 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8526 no | no | yes | yes
8527 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008528 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008529
8530 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8531
8532 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8533 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8534 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8535
8536 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8537 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8538 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8539 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8540 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8541 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8542 matches will assign the server.
8543
8544 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8545 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8546 with the next rules until one matches.
8547
8548 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8549 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8550 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8551 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8552
8553 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8554 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8555 stripped.
8556
8557 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8558 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8559 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8560 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8561
8562 Example :
8563 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8564 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8565 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8566 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8567 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8568 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8569 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8570 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8571 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8572
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008573 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008574
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008575
85765. Bind and Server options
8577--------------------------
8578
8579The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8580depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8581settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8582written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8583described in this section.
8584
8585
85865.1. Bind options
8587-----------------
8588
8589The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8590as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8591no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8592parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8593while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8594provided immediately after the setting name.
8595
8596The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8597
8598accept-proxy
8599 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008600 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8601 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008602 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8603 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8604 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8605 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8606 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8607 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8608 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008609 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8610 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008611
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008612alpn <protocols>
8613 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8614 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8615 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8616 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8617 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8618 initial NPN extension.
8619
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008620backlog <backlog>
8621 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8622 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8623
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008624ecdhe <named curve>
8625 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008626 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8627 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008628
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008629ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008630 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8631 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8632 client's certificate.
8633
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008634ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8636 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8637 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8638 error is ignored.
8639
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008640ciphers <ciphers>
8641 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8642 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008643 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008644 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8645 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8646
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008647crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008648 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8649 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8650 to verify client's certificate.
8651
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008652crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008653 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8654 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8655 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8656 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8657 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8658 file.
8659
8660 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8661 are loaded.
8662
8663 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008664 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
8665 '.issuer' or '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified
8666 multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8667 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
8668 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects.
8669 Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the
8670 first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008671 www.sub.example.org).
8672
8673 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8674 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8675 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8676 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008677 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8678 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008679
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008680 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008681
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008682 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8683 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008684 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008685 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8686 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8687 clients).
8688
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008689 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8690 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8691 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8692 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8693 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8694 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8695 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8696 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8697 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8698 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8699 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8700 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8701 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8702
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008703crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008704 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8705 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008706 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008707 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008708
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008709crt-list <file>
8710 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008711 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8712 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008713
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008714 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008715
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008716 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8717 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8718 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8719 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8720 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8721 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8722 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8723 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008724
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008725defer-accept
8726 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8727 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8728 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8729 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8730 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8731 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8732 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8733 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8734 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8735 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8736 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8737
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008738force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008739 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008740 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008741 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8742 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008743
8744force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008745 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008746 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8747 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008748
8749force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008750 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008751 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8752 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008753
8754force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008755 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008756 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8757 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008758
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008759gid <gid>
8760 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8761 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8762 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8763 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8764 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8765
8766group <group>
8767 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8768 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8769 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8770 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8771 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8772
8773id <id>
8774 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8775 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8776 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8777 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8778
8779interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008780 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8781 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8782 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8783 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8784 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8785 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8786 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008787
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008788level <level>
8789 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8790 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8791 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8792 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8793 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8794 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8795 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8796 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8797 counters).
8798 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8799 all counters).
8800
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008801maxconn <maxconn>
8802 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8803 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8804 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8805 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8806 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8807 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8808 eat all memory.
8809
8810mode <mode>
8811 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8812 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8813 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8814 UNIX sockets.
8815
8816mss <maxseg>
8817 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8818 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8819 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8820 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8821 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8822 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8823 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8824 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8825 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8826 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8827 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8828
8829name <name>
8830 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8831 page.
8832
8833nice <nice>
8834 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8835 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8836 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8837 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8838 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8839 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8840 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8841 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8842 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8843 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8844 one for an RDP socket.
8845
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008846no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008848 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008849 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008850 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8851 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008852 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008853
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008854no-tls-tickets
8855 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8856 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8857 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008858 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8859 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008860
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008861no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008862 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008863 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008864 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008865 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8866 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8867 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008868
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008869no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008871 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008872 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008873 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8874 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8875 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008876
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008877no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008879 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008880 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008881 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8882 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8883 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008884
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008885npn <protocols>
8886 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8887 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8888 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8889 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008890 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8891 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008892
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008893process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8894 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8895 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8896 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8897 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8898 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8899 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8900 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008901 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8902 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8903 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8904 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8905 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8906 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8907 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008908
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008909ssl
8910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008911 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008912 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8913 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8914 to deciphered contents.
8915
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008916strict-sni
8917 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8918 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8919 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8920 See the "crt" option for more information.
8921
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01008922tcp-ut <delay>
8923 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
8924 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
8925 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
8926 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
8927 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
8928 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
8929 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
8930 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
8931 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
8932 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
8933 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
8934
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008935tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008936 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008937 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8938 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8939 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8940 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8941 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8942 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8943 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008944 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8945 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8946 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008947
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008948transparent
8949 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8950 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8951 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8952 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8953 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8954 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8955 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8956 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8957 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8958 so check for support with your vendor.
8959
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008960v4v6
8961 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8962 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8963 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8964 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008965 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008966
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008967v6only
8968 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8969 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8970 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008971 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8972 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008973
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008974uid <uid>
8975 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8976 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8977 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8978 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8979 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8980
8981user <user>
8982 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8983 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8984 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8985 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8986 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8987
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008988verify [none|optional|required]
8989 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8990 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8991 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8992 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8993 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008994 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8995 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8996 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8997 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008998
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020089995.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009000------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009002The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9003which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9004arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9005settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9006after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9007Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9008address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009010 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009011 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009012
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009013The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009014
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009015addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009016 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9017 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9018 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9019 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9020 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009022 Supported in default-server: No
9023
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009024agent-check
9025 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009026 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9027 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9028 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9029 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009030
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009031 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009032 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009033 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9034 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9035 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009036
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009037 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9038 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009039
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009040 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9041 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9042 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009043
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009044 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9045 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9046 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009047
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009048 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9049 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9050 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9051 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9052 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9053 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9054 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009055
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009056 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9057 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009058
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009059 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9060 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9061 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9062 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9063 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9064 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9065 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9066 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9067 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009068
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009069 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9070 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009071 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9072 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9073 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9074 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009075
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009076 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9077 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009078
9079 Supported in default-server: No
9080
9081agent-inter <delay>
9082 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9083 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9084
9085 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9086 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9087 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9088 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9089 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9090 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9091 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9092 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9093 of backends use the same servers.
9094
9095 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9096
9097 Supported in default-server: Yes
9098
9099agent-port <port>
9100 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9101
9102 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9103
9104 Supported in default-server: Yes
9105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009106backup
9107 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9108 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9109 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9110 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9111 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9112 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009114 Supported in default-server: No
9115
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009116ca-file <cafile>
9117 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9118 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9119 server's certificate.
9120
9121 Supported in default-server: No
9122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009123check
9124 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009125 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9126 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9127 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9128 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9129 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9130 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9131 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009132 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9133 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9134 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009136 Supported in default-server: No
9137
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009138check-send-proxy
9139 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9140 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9141 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9142 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9143 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9144 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9145 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9146
9147 Supported in default-server: No
9148
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009149check-ssl
9150 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9151 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9152 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9153 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009154 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009155 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9156 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9157 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9158 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9159
9160 Supported in default-server: No
9161
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009162ciphers <ciphers>
9163 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009164 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009165 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9166 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9167 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9168 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9169 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9170 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9171
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009172 Supported in default-server: No
9173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009174cookie <value>
9175 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9176 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9177 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9178 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9179 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9180 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9181 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009183 Supported in default-server: No
9184
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009185crl-file <crlfile>
9186 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9187 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9188 to verify server's certificate.
9189
9190 Supported in default-server: No
9191
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009192crt <cert>
9193 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9194 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9195 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9196 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9197 certificate request.
9198
9199 Supported in default-server: No
9200
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009201disabled
9202 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9203 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9204 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9205 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9206 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9207
9208 Supported in default-server: No
9209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009210error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009211 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9212 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9213 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009215 Supported in default-server: Yes
9216
9217 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009219fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009220 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9221 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9222 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9223
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009224 Supported in default-server: Yes
9225
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009226force-sslv3
9227 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9228 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009229 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9230 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009231
9232 Supported in default-server: No
9233
9234force-tlsv10
9235 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009236 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9237 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009238
9239 Supported in default-server: No
9240
9241force-tlsv11
9242 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009243 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9244 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009245
9246 Supported in default-server: No
9247
9248force-tlsv12
9249 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009250 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9251 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009252
9253 Supported in default-server: No
9254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009255id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009256 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9257 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9258 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009260 Supported in default-server: No
9261
9262inter <delay>
9263fastinter <delay>
9264downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009265 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9266 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9267 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9268 between checks depending on the server state :
9269
9270 Server state | Interval used
9271 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9272 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9273 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9274 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9275 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9276 or yet unchecked. |
9277 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9278 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9279 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009281 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9282 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9283 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9284 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009285 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9286 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9287 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9288 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9289 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009291 Supported in default-server: Yes
9292
9293maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009294 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9295 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9296 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9297 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9298 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9299 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9300 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9301 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009303 Supported in default-server: Yes
9304
9305maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009306 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9307 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9308 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9309 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9310 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9311 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9312 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009314 Supported in default-server: Yes
9315
9316minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009317 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9318 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9319 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9320 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9321 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9322 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009323 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009324 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009326 Supported in default-server: Yes
9327
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009328no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009329 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9330 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009331 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009332
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009333 Supported in default-server: No
9334
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009335no-tls-tickets
9336 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9337 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9338 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009339 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9340 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009341
9342 Supported in default-server: No
9343
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009344no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009345 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009346 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9347 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009348 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9349 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9350 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009351
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009352 Supported in default-server: No
9353
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009354no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009355 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009356 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9357 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009358 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9359 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9360 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009361
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009362 Supported in default-server: No
9363
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009364no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009365 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009366 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9367 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009368 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9369 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9370 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009371
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009372 Supported in default-server: No
9373
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009374non-stick
9375 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9376 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9377 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9378
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009379 Supported in default-server: No
9380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009381observe <mode>
9382 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9383 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9384 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9385 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9386 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9387 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009388 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009390 Supported in default-server: No
9391
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009392 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9393
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009394on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009395 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9396 Currently, four modes are available:
9397 - fastinter: force fastinter
9398 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9399 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9400 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9401 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9402
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009403 Supported in default-server: Yes
9404
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009405 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9406
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009407on-marked-down <action>
9408 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9409 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009410 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9411 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9412 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9413 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9414 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9415 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9416 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9417 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009418
9419 Actions are disabled by default
9420
9421 Supported in default-server: Yes
9422
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009423on-marked-up <action>
9424 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9425 Currently one action is available:
9426 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9427 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9428 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9429 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9430 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9431 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9432 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9433 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9434
9435 Actions are disabled by default
9436
9437 Supported in default-server: Yes
9438
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009439port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009440 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9441 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9442 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9443 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9444 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9445 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9446
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009447 Supported in default-server: Yes
9448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009449redir <prefix>
9450 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9451 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9452 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9453 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9454 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9455 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9456 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9457 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009458 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009459 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9460 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9461 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9462 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9463 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9464
9465 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009467 Supported in default-server: No
9468
9469rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009470 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9471 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9472 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9473
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009474 Supported in default-server: Yes
9475
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009476send-proxy
9477 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9478 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9479 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9480 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9481 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9482 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9483 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9484 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9485 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009486 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9487 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9488 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9489 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9490 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009491
9492 Supported in default-server: No
9493
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009494send-proxy-v2
9495 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9496 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9497 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9498 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9499 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9500 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9501 option of the "bind" keyword.
9502
9503 Supported in default-server: No
9504
9505send-proxy-v2-ssl
9506 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9507 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9508 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9509 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9510 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9511 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9512 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9513 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9514
9515 Supported in default-server: No
9516
9517send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9518 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9519 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9520 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9521 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9522 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9523 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9524 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9525 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9526 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9527
9528 Supported in default-server: No
9529
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009530slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009531 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9532 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9533 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9534 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9535 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9536 parameters :
9537
9538 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9539 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9540
9541 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9542 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9543 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9544 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9545
9546 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9547 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9548 seen as failed.
9549
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009550 Supported in default-server: Yes
9551
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009552source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009553source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009554source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009555 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9556 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9557 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9558 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9559
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009560 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9561 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9562 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9563 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9564 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9565 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9566 server.
9567
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009568 Supported in default-server: No
9569
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009570ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009571 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9572 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9573 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9574 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9575 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9576 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009577 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009578
9579 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009581track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009582 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9583 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9584 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9585 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009586 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009588 Supported in default-server: No
9589
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009590verify [none|required]
9591 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009592 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9593 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9594 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9595 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009596 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9597 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9598 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009599
9600 Supported in default-server: No
9601
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009602verifyhost <hostname>
9603 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9604 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9605 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9606 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9607 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9608 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9609
9610 Supported in default-server: No
9611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009612weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009613 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9614 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9615 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009616 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9617 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9618 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9619 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9620 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9621 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009622
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009623 Supported in default-server: Yes
9624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009625
96266. HTTP header manipulation
9627---------------------------
9628
9629In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9630response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9631request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9632which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009633against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009634
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009635If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9636to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9637but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9638HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9639stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9640because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9641a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9642still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009644This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9645in section 4.2 :
9646
9647 - reqadd <string>
9648 - reqallow <search>
9649 - reqiallow <search>
9650 - reqdel <search>
9651 - reqidel <search>
9652 - reqdeny <search>
9653 - reqideny <search>
9654 - reqpass <search>
9655 - reqipass <search>
9656 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9657 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9658 - reqtarpit <search>
9659 - reqitarpit <search>
9660 - rspadd <string>
9661 - rspdel <search>
9662 - rspidel <search>
9663 - rspdeny <search>
9664 - rspideny <search>
9665 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9666 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9667
9668With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9669is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9670parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9671prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9672Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9673
9674 \t for a tab
9675 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9676 \n for a new line (LF)
9677 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9678 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9679 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9680 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9681 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9682
9683The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9684portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9685above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9686regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
96879 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9688is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9689
9690The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9691after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9692
9693Notes related to these keywords :
9694---------------------------------
9695 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9696 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9697 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9698
9699 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9700 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9701 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9702
9703 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9704 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9705 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9706 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9707 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9708
9709 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9710 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9711 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9712 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9713 useless headers before adding new ones.
9714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009715 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009716 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9717
9718 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9719 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9720 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9721
9722 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9723 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009724 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009725
9726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097277. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9728----------------------------------
9729
9730Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9731client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9732The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9733these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9734but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9735data called patterns.
9736
9737
97387.1. ACL basics
9739---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009740
9741The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9742content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9743from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9744simple :
9745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009746 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009747 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009748 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9749 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009751The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9752adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009753
9754In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009756 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009757
9758This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9759Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9760and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009761an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9762conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9763as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9764are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009765
9766ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9767'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9768which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9769
9770There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9771performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009773The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9774specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9775this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009776methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9777ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009778
9779Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9780 - boolean
9781 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9782 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9783 - string
9784 - data block
9785
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009786Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9787converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9788would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9789The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9790which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9791
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009792Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9793keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9794fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9795which are summarized in the table below :
9796
9797 +---------------------+-----------------+
9798 | Sample or converter | Default |
9799 | output type | matching method |
9800 +---------------------+-----------------+
9801 | boolean | bool |
9802 +---------------------+-----------------+
9803 | integer | int |
9804 +---------------------+-----------------+
9805 | ip | ip |
9806 +---------------------+-----------------+
9807 | string | str |
9808 +---------------------+-----------------+
9809 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9810 +---------------------+-----------------+
9811
9812Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9813matching method, see below.
9814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009815The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9816 - boolean
9817 - integer or integer range
9818 - IP address / network
9819 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9820 - regular expression
9821 - hex block
9822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009823The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9824
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009825 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9826 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009827 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009828 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009829 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009830 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009831 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009833The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9834read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9835if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9836lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9837will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9838beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9839a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9840lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9841exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9842
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009843The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9844parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9845ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9846a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9847check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9848
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009849The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9850socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9851file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009853Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9854loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9855
9856 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9857
9858In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9859the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9860case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9861as well.
9862
9863The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9864sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9865do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9866methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9867is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9868obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9869followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9870default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9871that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9872string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9873
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009874The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9875By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9876string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9877resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9878server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9879waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9880flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9881function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009883There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9884sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9885be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009886
9887 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9888 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009889 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9890 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9891 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9892 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009893
9894 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9895 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009896 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009897
9898 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009899 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009900
9901 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009902 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009903
9904 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9905 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9906
9907 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9908 binary or string samples.
9909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009910 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9911 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009913 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9914 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9915 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009917 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9918 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009920 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9921 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009923 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9924 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009926 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9927 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009928 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009930 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9931 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9932 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009933
9934For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9935request, it is possible to do :
9936
9937 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9938
9939In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9940buffer, one would use the following acl :
9941
9942 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9943
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009944On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9945possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9946
9947 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009949All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9950criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9951method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9952to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9953criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9954the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009956If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009957the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9958For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009960 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9961 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9962 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9963 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009964
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009965
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009966The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9967types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9968combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9969brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9970default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009972 +-------------------------------------------------+
9973 | Input sample type |
9974 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009975 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009976 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9977 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9978 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009979 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009980 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009981 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009982 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009983 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009984 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009985 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009986 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009987 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009988 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009989 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009990 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009991 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009992 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009993 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009994 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009995 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009996 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009997 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009998 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009999 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010000 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10001 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10002 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010003
10004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200100057.1.1. Matching booleans
10006------------------------
10007
10008In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10009Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10010When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10011that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10012
10013Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10014return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10015"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10016
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200100187.1.2. Matching integers
10019------------------------
10020
10021Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10022enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10023to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10024
10025Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10026matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10027lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010028
10029For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10030unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10031representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10032
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010033As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10034two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10035instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10036ranges and operators.
10037
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010038For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010039operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10040Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10041of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010042
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010043Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010044
10045 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10046 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10047 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10048 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10049 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10050
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010051For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010052
10053 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10054
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010055This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10056
10057 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10058
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200100607.1.3. Matching strings
10061-----------------------
10062
10063String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10064different forms :
10065
10066 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10067 patterns ;
10068
10069 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10070 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10071
10072 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10073 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10074
10075 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10076 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10077
10078 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10079 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10080 matches.
10081
10082 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10083 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10084 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010085
10086String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10087exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10088characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10089string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10090to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010091before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010092
10093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200100947.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10095---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010096
10097Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10098they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10099possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10100passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10101the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010102the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10103match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010104
10105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101067.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10107-------------------------------------
10108
10109It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10110not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10111a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10112to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10113digits may be used upper or lower case.
10114
10115Example :
10116 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10117 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10118
10119
101207.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10121---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010122
10123IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10124netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10125within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010126host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010127difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10128at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10129does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10130parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010131
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010132IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10133Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10134trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10135IPv6 patterns.
10136
10137HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10138following situations :
10139 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10140 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10141 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10142 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10143 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10144 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10145 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10146 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10147 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10148 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010150
101517.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10152----------------------------------
10153
10154Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10155combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10156
10157 - AND (implicit)
10158 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10159 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010161A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010163 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010165Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10166indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010168For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10169"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10170requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10171is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10172
10173 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10174 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10175 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10176 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10177
10178To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10179and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10180
10181 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10182 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10183 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10184 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10185
10186 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10187 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10188 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10189 use_backend www if host_www
10190
10191It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10192expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10193be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10194the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10195
10196 The following rule :
10197
10198 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10199 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10200
10201 Can also be written that way :
10202
10203 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10204
10205It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10206to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10207simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10208sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10209good use is the following :
10210
10211 With named ACLs :
10212
10213 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10214 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10215 monitor fail if site_dead
10216
10217 With anonymous ACLs :
10218
10219 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10220
10221See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10222
10223
102247.3. Fetching samples
10225---------------------
10226
10227Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10228against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10229sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10230ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10231of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10232available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10233
10234This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10235Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10236compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10237deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10238
10239The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10240matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10241method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10242indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10243
10244As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10245when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10246mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10247the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10248ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10249
10250Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10251multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10252when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10253incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10254are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10255is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10256all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10257
10258Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10259 - name
10260 - name(arg1)
10261 - name(arg1,arg2)
10262
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010263
102647.3.1. Converters
10265-----------------
10266
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010267Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10268of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10269is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10270was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10271has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10272unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10273
10274These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10275sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10276the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10277support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010278
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010279A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10280support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10281supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10282(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10283bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010285The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010286
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010287add(<value>)
10288 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10289 result as an unsigned integer.
10290
10291and(<value>)
10292 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10293 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10294
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010295base64
10296 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10297 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10298 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10299
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010300bool
10301 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10302 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10303 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10304 presence of a flag).
10305
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010306bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10307 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10308 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10309 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10310
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010311cpl
10312 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
10313 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10314
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010315crc32([<avalanche>])
10316 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10317 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10318 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10319 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10320 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10321 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10322 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10323 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10324 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10325 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10326 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10327
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010328div(<value>)
10329 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10330 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
10331 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
10332
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010333djb2([<avalanche>])
10334 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10335 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10336 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10337 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10338 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10339 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10340 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010341 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10342 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010343
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010344even
10345 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
10346 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
10347
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010348field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10349 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10350 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10351 list of chars.
10352
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010353hex
10354 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10355 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10356 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10357 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010358
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010359http_date([<offset>])
10360 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10361 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10362 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10363 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10364 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10365 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010366
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010367in_table(<table>)
10368 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10369 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10370 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10371 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10372 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10373
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010374ipmask(<mask>)
10375 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10376 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10377 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10378 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10379
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010380json([<input-code>])
10381 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10382 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10383 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10384 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10385 of errors:
10386 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10387 bytes, ...)
10388 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10389 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10390
10391 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10392 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10393 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10394 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10395 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10396 are :
10397 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10398 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10399 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10400 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10401 error ;
10402 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10403 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10404
10405 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10406 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10407
10408 Example:
10409 capture request header user-agent len 150
10410 capture request header Host len 15
10411 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10412
10413 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10414 GET / HTTP/1.0
10415 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10416
10417 Output log:
10418 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10419
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010420language(<value>[,<default>])
10421 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10422 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10423 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10424 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10425 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10426 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10427 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10428 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10429 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10430 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10431 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10432 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010433
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010434 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010435
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010436 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10437 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010438
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010439 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10440 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10441 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10442 use_backend spanish if es
10443 use_backend french if fr
10444 use_backend english if en
10445 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010446
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010447lower
10448 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10449 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10450 type. The result is of type string.
10451
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010452ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10453 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10454 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10455 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10456 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10457 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10458 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10459
10460 Example :
10461
10462 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10463 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10464 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10465
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010466map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10467map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10468map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10469 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10470 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10471 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10472 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10473 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10474 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10475 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10476 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010477
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010478 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10479 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10480 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010481
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010482 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10483 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010484
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010485 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10486 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10487 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10488 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010489 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10490 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010491 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10492 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10493 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10494 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10495 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10496 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10497 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10498 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10499 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10500 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10501 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10502 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10503 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10504 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010505
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010506 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10507 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10508 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10509 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10510 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010511
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010512 Example :
10513
10514 # this is a comment and is ignored
10515 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10516 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10517 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10518 | | | `---------- value
10519 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10520 | `---------------------------- key
10521 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10522
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010523mod(<value>)
10524 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10525 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
10526
10527mul(<value>)
10528 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
10529 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
10530 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
10531
10532neg
10533 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
10534 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
10535 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
10536 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10537
10538not
10539 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10540 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10541 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10542 absence of a flag).
10543
10544odd
10545 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
10546 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
10547
10548or(<value>)
10549 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10550 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10551
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010010552regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010010553 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
10554 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
10555 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
10556 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
10557 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
10558 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
10559 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
10560 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
10561 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
10562 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
10563 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
10564 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
10565 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
10566
10567 Example :
10568
10569 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
10570 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
10571 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
10572 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
10573
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010574sdbm([<avalanche>])
10575 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10576 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10577 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10578 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10579 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10580 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10581 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010582 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
10583 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010584
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010585sub(<value>)
10586 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
10587 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
10588 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10589
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010590table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10591 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10592 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10593 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10594 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10595 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10596 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10597
10598
10599table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10600 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10601 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10602 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10603 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10604 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10605 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10606
10607table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10608 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10609 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10610 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10611 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10612 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10613
10614table_conn_cur(<table>)
10615 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10616 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10617 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10618 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10619 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10620
10621table_conn_rate(<table>)
10622 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10623 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10624 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10625 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10626 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10627
10628table_gpc0(<table>)
10629 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10630 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10631 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10632 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10633 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10634
10635table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10636 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10637 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10638 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10639 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10640 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10641 sample fetch keyword.
10642
10643table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10644 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10645 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10646 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10647 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10648 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10649
10650table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10651 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10652 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10653 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10654 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10655 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10656 keyword.
10657
10658table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10659 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10660 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10661 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10662 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10663 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10664
10665table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10666 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10667 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10668 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10669 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10670 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10671 keyword.
10672
10673table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10674 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10675 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10676 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10677 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10678 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10679 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10680 keyword.
10681
10682table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10683 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10684 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10685 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10686 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10687 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10688 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10689 keyword.
10690
10691table_server_id(<table>)
10692 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10693 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10694 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10695 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10696 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10697 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10698
10699table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10700 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10701 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10702 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10703 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10704 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10705 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10706 keyword.
10707
10708table_sess_rate(<table>)
10709 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10710 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10711 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10712 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10713 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10714 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10715 keyword.
10716
10717table_trackers(<table>)
10718 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10719 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10720 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10721 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10722 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10723 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10724 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10725 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10726 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10727 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10728
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010729upper
10730 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10731 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10732 type. The result is of type string.
10733
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010734utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10735 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10736 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10737 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10738 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10739 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10740 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10741
10742 Example :
10743
10744 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10745 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10746 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10747
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010748word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10749 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10750 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10751
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010752wt6([<avalanche>])
10753 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10754 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10755 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10756 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10757 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10758 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10759 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010760 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
10761 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010762
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010763xor(<value>)
10764 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
10765 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10766
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010767
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200107687.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010769--------------------------------------------
10770
10771A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10772not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10773"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10774The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10775
10776always_false : boolean
10777 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10778 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10779
10780always_true : boolean
10781 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10782 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10783
10784avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010785 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010786 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10787 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10788 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10789 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10790 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10791 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10792 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10793 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10794 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10795 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10796 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10797 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10798 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010800be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010801 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10802 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10803 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10804 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10805 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010807be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10808 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10809 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10810 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10811 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10812 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10813 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010814
10815 Example :
10816 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10817 backend dynamic
10818 mode http
10819 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10820 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010822connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10823 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010824 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010825 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10826 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010827
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010828 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010829 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010830 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10831
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010832 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10833 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010834
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010835 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010836 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010837 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010838 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10839 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010840 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010841 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010842
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010843 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10844 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010845 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010846 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010847
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010848date([<offset>]) : integer
10849 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10850 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10851 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10852 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010853 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10854
10855 Example :
10856
10857 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10858 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010859
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010860env(<name>) : string
10861 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10862 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10863 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10864 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10865 certain way.
10866
10867 Examples :
10868 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10869 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10870
10871 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10872 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010874fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10875 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010876 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10877 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010878 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10879 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10880 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10881 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10882 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010884fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10885 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10886 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10887 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10888 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10889 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10890 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10891 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10892 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010893
10894 Example :
10895 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10896 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10897 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10898 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10899 frontend mail
10900 bind :25
10901 mode tcp
10902 maxconn 100
10903 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10904 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10905 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10906 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010907
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010908nbproc : integer
10909 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10910 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10911 and debugging purposes.
10912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010913nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10914 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10915 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10916 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010917 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10918 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10919 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010920
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010921proc : integer
10922 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10923 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10924 debugging purposes.
10925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010926queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010927 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10928 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10929 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010930 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10931 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10932 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10933 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10934 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10935
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010936rand([<range>]) : integer
10937 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10938 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10939 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10940 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10941 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010943srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10944 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10945 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10946 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10947 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10948 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10949 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10950 methods.
10951
10952srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10953 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10954 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10955 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10956 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10957 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10958 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10959 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10960
10961srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10962 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10963 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010964 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010965 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10966 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10967 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10968 overloading servers).
10969
10970 Example :
10971 # Redirect to a separate back
10972 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10973 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10974 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10975
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010976stopping : boolean
10977 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10978 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10979 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010981table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10982 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10983 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10984
10985table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10986 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10987 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10988 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10989
10990
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109917.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010992----------------------------------
10993
10994The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10995closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10996methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10997sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10998TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010999the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11000counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11001"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011002argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11003the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11004this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011005
11006be_id : integer
11007 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11008 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11009
11010dst : ip
11011 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11012 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11013 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11014 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11015 RFC 4291.
11016
11017dst_conn : integer
11018 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11019 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11020 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11021 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11022 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11023 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11024 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11025 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011027dst_port : integer
11028 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11029 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11030 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11031 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11032 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11033 an HTTP header.
11034
11035fe_id : integer
11036 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11037 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11038 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11039
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011040sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011041sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11042sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11043sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011044 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11045 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11046 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11047
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011048sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011049sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11050sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11051sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011052 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11053 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11054 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11055
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011056sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011057sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11058sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11059sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011060 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11061 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011062 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11063 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11064 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011065
11066 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11067 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011068 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11069 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11070 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011071 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11072 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011074sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011075sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11076sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11077sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011078 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11079 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11080
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011081sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011082sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11083sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11084sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011085 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11086 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11087 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11088
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011089sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011090sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11091sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11092sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011093 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11094 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11095 See also src_conn_rate.
11096
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011097sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011098sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11099sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11100sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011101 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011102 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011103
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011104sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011105sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11106sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11107sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011108 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11109 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11110 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011111 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11112 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11113 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011114
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011115sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011116sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11117sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11118sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011119 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11120 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11121 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11122
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011123sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011124sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11125sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11126sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011127 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11128 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11129 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11130 src_http_err_rate.
11131
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011132sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011133sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11134sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11135sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011136 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11137 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11138 src_http_req_cnt.
11139
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011140sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011141sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11142sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11143sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011144 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11145 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11146 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11147 src_http_req_rate.
11148
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011149sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011150sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11151sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11152sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011153 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011154 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11155 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11156 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11157 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011158
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011159 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11160 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011161 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11162
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011163sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011164sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11165sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11166sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011167 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11168 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11169 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011170
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011171sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011172sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11173sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11174sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011175 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11176 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11177 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011178
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011179sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011180sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11181sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11182sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011183 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11184 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11185 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11186 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011187 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011188 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11189
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011190sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011191sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11192sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11193sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011194 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11195 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11196 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11197 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11198 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011199 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011200
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011201sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011202sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11203sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11204sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011205 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11206 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11207 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11208
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011209sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011210sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11211sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11212sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011213 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11214 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011215 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011216 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11217 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011218 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11219 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11220 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011222so_id : integer
11223 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11224 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11225 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011227src : ip
11228 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
11229 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11230 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11231 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11232 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11233 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11234 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011235
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011236 Example:
11237 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11238 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011240src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11241 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11242 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11243 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011244 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011246src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11247 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11248 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011249 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011250 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011252src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11253 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11254 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11255 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11256 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11257 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11258 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011259
11260 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11261 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11262 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11263 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011264 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011265 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11266 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011268src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011269 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011270 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011271 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011272 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011274src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011275 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011276 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11277 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011278 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011280src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11281 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11282 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11283 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011284 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011286src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011287 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011288 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011289 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011290 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011292src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011293 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011294 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011295 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11296 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011297 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11298 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11299 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011301src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11302 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11303 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011304 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011305 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011306 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011308src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11309 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11310 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11311 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11312 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011313 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011315src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11316 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11317 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11318 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011319 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011321src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11322 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11323 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11324 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011325 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011326 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011328src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11329 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11330 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11331 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011332 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011333 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11334 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011335
11336 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011337 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011338 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011340src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011341 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11342 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11343 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11344 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11345 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011347src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011348 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11349 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11350 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11351 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11352 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011354src_port : integer
11355 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11356 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11357 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11358 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011360src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11361 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011362 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11363 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11364 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011365 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011367src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11368 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11369 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11370 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11371 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011372 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011374src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11375 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11376 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11377 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11378 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11379 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11380 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11381 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11382 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011383
11384 Example :
11385 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11386 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11387 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11388 listen ssh
11389 bind :22
11390 mode tcp
11391 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011392 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011393 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011394 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011396srv_id : integer
11397 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11398 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11399 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011400
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011401
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200114027.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011403----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011405The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11406closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11407when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11408usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011409future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011410
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011411ssl_bc : boolean
11412 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11413 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11414 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11415
11416ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11417 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11418 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11419
11420ssl_bc_cipher : string
11421 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11422 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11423
11424ssl_bc_protocol : string
11425 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11426 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11427
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011428ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011429 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011430 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11431 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011432
11433ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11434 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11435 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11436 if session was reused or not.
11437
11438ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11439 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11440 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011442ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11443 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11444 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11445 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11446 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11447 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011449ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11450 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11451 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11452 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11453 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011454
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011455ssl_c_der : binary
11456 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11457 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11458 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011460ssl_c_err : integer
11461 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11462 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11463 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11464 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11465 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011467ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11468 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11469 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11470 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11471 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11472 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11473 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11474 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11475 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011477ssl_c_key_alg : string
11478 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11479 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11480 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011482ssl_c_notafter : string
11483 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11484 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11485 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011487ssl_c_notbefore : string
11488 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11489 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11490 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011492ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11493 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11494 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11495 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11496 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11497 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11498 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11499 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11500 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011502ssl_c_serial : binary
11503 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11504 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11505 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11508 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11509 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11510 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011511 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11512 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11513
11514 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011516ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11517 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11518 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11519 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011521ssl_c_used : boolean
11522 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11523 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011525ssl_c_verify : integer
11526 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11527 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11528 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11529 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011531ssl_c_version : integer
11532 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11533 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011534
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011535ssl_f_der : binary
11536 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11537 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11538 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011540ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11541 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11542 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11543 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11544 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011545 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011546 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11547 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11548 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011550ssl_f_key_alg : string
11551 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11552 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11553 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011555ssl_f_notafter : string
11556 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11557 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11558 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011560ssl_f_notbefore : string
11561 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11562 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11563 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011565ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11566 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11567 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11568 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11569 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11570 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11571 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11572 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11573 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011575ssl_f_serial : binary
11576 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11577 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11578 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011579
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011580ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11581 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11582 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11583 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011585ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11586 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11587 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11588 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011590ssl_f_version : integer
11591 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11592 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11593
11594ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011595 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11596 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11597 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011599 Example :
11600 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11601 listen http-https
11602 bind :80
11603 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11604 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11605
11606ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11607 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11608 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11609
11610ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011611 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011612 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11613 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11614 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11615 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11616 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11617 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11618 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11619 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011621ssl_fc_cipher : string
11622 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11623 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011625ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011626 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11627 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011628 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11629 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11630 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11631 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011633ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11634 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011635 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11636 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11637 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11638 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011640ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011641 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011642 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11643 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11644 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11645 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11646 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11647 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11648 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011650ssl_fc_protocol : string
11651 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11652 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011653
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011654ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011655 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011656 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11657 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011659ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11660 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11661 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11662 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11663 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011665ssl_fc_sni : string
11666 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11667 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11668 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11669 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11670 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11671
11672 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11673 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11674 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011675 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11676 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011678 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011679 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11680 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011682ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11683 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11684 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011685
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011686
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200116877.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011688------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011690Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11691sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11692only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11693For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11694be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11695can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11696sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11697for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11698content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011700payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11701 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11702 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11703 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011705payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11706 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11707 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11708 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011710req.len : integer
11711req_len : integer (deprecated)
11712 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11713 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11714 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11715 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11716 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11717 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11718 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11719 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011721req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11722 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011723 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11724 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11725 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11726 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011728 ACL alternatives :
11729 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011731req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11732 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11733 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11734 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11735 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011737 ACL alternatives :
11738 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011740 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011742req.proto_http : boolean
11743req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11744 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11745 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11746 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11747 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11748 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11749 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11750 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011752 Example:
11753 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11754 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11755 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011756 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011758req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11759rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11760 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11761 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11762 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11763 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11764 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11765 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11766 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011768 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11769 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11770 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11771 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11772 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11773 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011775 ACL derivatives :
11776 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011778 Example :
11779 listen tse-farm
11780 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11781 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11782 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11783 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11784 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11785 persist rdp-cookie
11786 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11787 # This is only useful makes sense if
11788 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11789 stick-table type string size 204800
11790 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11791 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11792 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011794 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11795 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011797req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11798rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11799 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11800 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11801 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11802 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011804 ACL derivatives :
11805 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011807req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11808req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11809 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11810 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11811 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11812 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11813 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11814 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11815 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011817req.ssl_sni : string
11818req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11819 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11820 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11821 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11822 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11823 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11824 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11825 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11826 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11827 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11828 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11829 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11830 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011832 ACL derivatives :
11833 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011835 Examples :
11836 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11837 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11838 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11839 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11840 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011842res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11843rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11844 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11845 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11846 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11847 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11848 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11849 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11850 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011852req.ssl_ver : integer
11853req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11854 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11855 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11856 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11857 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11858 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11859 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11860 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11861 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11862 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011864 ACL derivatives :
11865 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011866
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011867res.len : integer
11868 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11869 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11870 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11871 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11872 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11873 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11874 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11875 content inspection.
11876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011877res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11878 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011879 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11880 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11881 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11882 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011884res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11885 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11886 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11887 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11888 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011890 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011892wait_end : boolean
11893 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11894 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11895 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11896 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11897 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11898 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11899 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11900 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011902 Examples :
11903 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11904 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11905 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011907 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11908 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11909 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11910 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11911 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11912 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11913 tcp-request content reject
11914
11915
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200119167.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011917--------------------------------------
11918
11919It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11920This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11921data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11922its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11923HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11924content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11925to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11926more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11927response are indexed.
11928
11929base : string
11930 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11931 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11932 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11933 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11934 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11935 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11936 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11937 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11938
11939 ACL derivatives :
11940 base : exact string match
11941 base_beg : prefix match
11942 base_dir : subdir match
11943 base_dom : domain match
11944 base_end : suffix match
11945 base_len : length match
11946 base_reg : regex match
11947 base_sub : substring match
11948
11949base32 : integer
11950 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11951 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11952 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011953 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
11954 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
11955 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011956
11957base32+src : binary
11958 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11959 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11960 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11961 per-URL counters.
11962
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011963capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11964 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11965 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11966 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11967
11968capture.req.method : string
11969 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11970 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11971 because it's allocated.
11972
11973capture.req.uri : string
11974 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11975 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11976 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11977 allocated.
11978
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011979capture.req.ver : string
11980 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11981 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11982 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11983
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011984capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11985 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11986 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11987 The first entry is an index of 0.
11988 See also: "capture response header"
11989
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011990capture.res.ver : string
11991 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11992 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11993 persistent flag.
11994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011995req.cook([<name>]) : string
11996cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11997 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11998 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11999 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12000 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12001 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12002 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12003 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12004 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12005
12006 ACL derivatives :
12007 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12008 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12009 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12010 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12011 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12012 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12013 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12014 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012016req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12017cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12018 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12019 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012021req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12022cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12023 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12024 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12025 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12026 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012028cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12029 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12030 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12031 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12032 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12033 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12034 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12035 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12036 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12037 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12038 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012040hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12041 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12042 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12043 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12044 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012045 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012047req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12048 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12049 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12050 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12051 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12052 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12053 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12054 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12055 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012057req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12058 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12059 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12060 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12061 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012063req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12064 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12065 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12066 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12067 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12068 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12069 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12070 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12071 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12072 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12073 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12074 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012076 ACL derivatives :
12077 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12078 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12079 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12080 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12081 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12082 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12083 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12084 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12085
12086req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12087hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12088 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12089 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12090 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12091 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12092 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12093 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12094 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12095 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12096 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12097
12098req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12099hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12100 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12101 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12102 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12103 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12104 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12105 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12106 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12107 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12108
12109req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12110hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12111 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12112 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12113 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12114 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12115 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12116 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12117 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12118
12119http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12120 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12121 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12122 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12123 basic auth is supported.
12124
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012125http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12126 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12127 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12128 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12129 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012130 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12131 basic auth is supported.
12132
12133 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012134 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12135 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12136 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12137 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012138
12139http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012140 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12141 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012142 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12143 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012145method : integer + string
12146 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12147 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12148 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12149 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12150 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12151 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12152 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012154 ACL derivatives :
12155 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012157 Example :
12158 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12159 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12160 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012162path : string
12163 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12164 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12165 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12166 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12167 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12168 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12169 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012171 ACL derivatives :
12172 path : exact string match
12173 path_beg : prefix match
12174 path_dir : subdir match
12175 path_dom : domain match
12176 path_end : suffix match
12177 path_len : length match
12178 path_reg : regex match
12179 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012180
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012181query : string
12182 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12183 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12184 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12185 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12186 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12187 which stops before the question mark.
12188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012189req.ver : string
12190req_ver : string (deprecated)
12191 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
12192 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
12193 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012195 ACL derivatives :
12196 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012198res.comp : boolean
12199 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
12200 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
12201 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012203res.comp_algo : string
12204 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
12205 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
12206 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012208res.cook([<name>]) : string
12209scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12210 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12211 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12212 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012214 ACL derivatives :
12215 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012217res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12218scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12219 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12220 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
12221 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012223res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12224scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12225 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12226 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
12227 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012229res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12230 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12231 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12232 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12233 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12234 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12235 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12236 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12237 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12238 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012240res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12241 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12242 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12243 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12244 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12245 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012247res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12248shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12249 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12250 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12251 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12252 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12253 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12254 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12255 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12256 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012258 ACL derivatives :
12259 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12260 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12261 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12262 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12263 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12264 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12265 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12266 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12267
12268res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12269shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12270 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12271 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12272 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12273 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12274 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012276res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12277shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12278 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12279 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12280 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12281 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12282 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12283 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012285res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12286shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12287 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12288 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12289 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12290 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12291 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12292 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012294res.ver : string
12295resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12296 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12297 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012299 ACL derivatives :
12300 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012302set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12303 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12304 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12305 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12306 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012308 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12309 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012311 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012313status : integer
12314 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12315 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12316 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012318url : string
12319 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12320 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12321 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12322 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12323 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12324 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12325 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012327 ACL derivatives :
12328 url : exact string match
12329 url_beg : prefix match
12330 url_dir : subdir match
12331 url_dom : domain match
12332 url_end : suffix match
12333 url_len : length match
12334 url_reg : regex match
12335 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012337url_ip : ip
12338 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12339 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12340 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12341 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12342 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12343 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12344 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012346url_port : integer
12347 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12348 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12349 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12350 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012352urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12353url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12354 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12355 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
12356 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
12357 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
12358 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
12359 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12360 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12361 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12362 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012364 ACL derivatives :
12365 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12366 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12367 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12368 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12369 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12370 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12371 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12372 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012373
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012375 Example :
12376 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12377 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12378 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12379 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012381urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12382 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12383 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12384 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012385
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123877.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012388---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012390Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12391every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012392order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012394ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12395---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012396FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012397HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012398HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12399HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012400HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12401HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12402HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12403HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12404LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012405METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12406METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12407METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12408METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12409METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12410METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012411RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012412REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012413TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012414WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12415---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012416
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124188. Logging
12419----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012420
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012421One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12422provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12423very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12424provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12425state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012426to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012427headers.
12428
12429In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12430about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12431send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12432
12433 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12434 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12435 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12436 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12437 at the termination.
12438
12439The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12440allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12441as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12442while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12443real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12444delay.
12445
12446
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124478.1. Log levels
12448---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012449
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012450TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012451source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012452HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12453in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12454track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12455syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12456about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012457
12458
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124598.2. Log formats
12460----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012461
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012462HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012463and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12464slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12465options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012466
12467 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12468 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12469 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12470 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12471 extents.
12472
12473 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12474 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12475 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12476 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12477 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12478
12479 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12480 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12481 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12482 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12483 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12484
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012485 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12486 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12487 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12488 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12489
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012490 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12491
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012492Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12493specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12494field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12495servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12496always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12497identifier.
12498
12499Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12500 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12501 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12502 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12503 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12504
12505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125068.2.1. Default log format
12507-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012508
12509This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12510as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12511format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12512
12513 Example :
12514 listen www
12515 mode http
12516 log global
12517 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12518
12519 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12520 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12521 (www/HTTP)
12522
12523 Field Format Extract from the example above
12524 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12525 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12526 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12527 4 'to' to
12528 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12529 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12530
12531Detailed fields description :
12532 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12533 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12534 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12535 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12536 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12537 and processed the connection.
12538 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12539
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012540In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12541"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12542connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12543
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012544It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12545will eventually disappear.
12546
12547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125488.2.2. TCP log format
12549---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012550
12551The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12552is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12553information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12554counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12555emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12556environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12557the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12558sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012559specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12560not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12561fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12562marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012563
12564 Example :
12565 frontend fnt
12566 mode tcp
12567 option tcplog
12568 log global
12569 default_backend bck
12570
12571 backend bck
12572 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12573
12574 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12575 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12576 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12577
12578 Field Format Extract from the example above
12579 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12580 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12581 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12582 4 frontend_name fnt
12583 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12584 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12585 7 bytes_read* 212
12586 8 termination_state --
12587 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12588 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12589
12590Detailed fields description :
12591 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012592 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12593 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12594 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12595 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12596 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012597
12598 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012599 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12600 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12601 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012602
12603 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12604 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12605 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12606 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12607
12608 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12609 and processed the connection.
12610
12611 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12612 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12613 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12614 applications.
12615
12616 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12617 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12618 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12619 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12620 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12621
12622 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12623 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12624 See "Timers" below for more details.
12625
12626 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12627 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12628 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12629 "Timers" below for more details.
12630
12631 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012632 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012633 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12634 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12635 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12636 details.
12637
12638 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12639 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12640 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12641 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12642 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12643
12644 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12645 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12646 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12647 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12648 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12649 for more details.
12650
12651 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012652 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012653 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12654 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12655 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012656 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012657
12658 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12659 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12660 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12661 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12662 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12663 caused by a denial of service attack.
12664
12665 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12666 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12667 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12668 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12669 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12670 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12671 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12672 denial of service attack.
12673
12674 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12675 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12676 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12677 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12678 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12679 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12680 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12681 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12682 be processed than on other servers.
12683
12684 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12685 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12686 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12687 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12688 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12689 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12690 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12691 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12692 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12693 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12694 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12695 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12696 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12697
12698 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12699 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12700 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12701 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12702 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12703 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12704 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12705 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12706
12707 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12708 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12709 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12710 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12711 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12712 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12713 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12714 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12715 occurs.
12716
12717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127188.2.3. HTTP log format
12719----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012720
12721The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12722is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12723the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12724are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12725emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12726generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12727"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12728which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012729frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12730is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012731
12732Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12733slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12734with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12735
12736 Example :
12737 frontend http-in
12738 mode http
12739 option httplog
12740 log global
12741 default_backend bck
12742
12743 backend static
12744 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12745
12746 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12747 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12748 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012749 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012750
12751 Field Format Extract from the example above
12752 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12753 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12754 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12755 4 frontend_name http-in
12756 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12757 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12758 7 status_code 200
12759 8 bytes_read* 2750
12760 9 captured_request_cookie -
12761 10 captured_response_cookie -
12762 11 termination_state ----
12763 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12764 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12765 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12766 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12767 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012768
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012769
12770Detailed fields description :
12771 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012772 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12773 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12774 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12775 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12776 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012777
12778 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012779 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12780 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12781 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012782
12783 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12784 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12785 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12786 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12787 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12788
12789 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12790 and processed the connection.
12791
12792 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12793 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12794 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12795
12796 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12797 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12798 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12799 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12800 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12801 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12802
12803 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12804 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12805 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12806 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12807 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12808 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12809
12810 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12811 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12812 See "Timers" below for more details.
12813
12814 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12815 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12816 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12817 below for more details.
12818
12819 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12820 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12821 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12822 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12823 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12824 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12825 for more details.
12826
12827 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012828 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012829 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12830 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12831 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12832 details.
12833
12834 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12835 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12836 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12837
12838 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12839 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12840 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12841 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12842 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12843 overflowing.
12844
12845 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12846 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12847 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12848 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12849 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12850 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12851 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12852 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12853
12854 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12855 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12856 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12857 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12858 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12859 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12860 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12861 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12862
12863 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12864 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12865 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12866 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12867 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12868 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12869 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12870
12871 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012872 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012873 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12874 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12875 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012876 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012877 system.
12878
12879 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12880 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12881 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12882 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12883 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12884 caused by a denial of service attack.
12885
12886 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12887 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12888 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12889 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12890 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12891 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12892 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12893 denial of service attack.
12894
12895 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12896 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12897 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12898 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12899 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12900 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12901 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12902 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12903 processed than on other servers.
12904
12905 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12906 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12907 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12908 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12909 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12910 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12911 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12912 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12913 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12914 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12915 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12916 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12917 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12918
12919 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12920 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12921 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12922 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12923 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12924 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12925 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12926 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12927
12928 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12929 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12930 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12931 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12932 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12933 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12934 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12935 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12936 occurs.
12937
12938 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12939 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12940 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12941 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12942 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12943 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12944 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12945 cookies" below for more details.
12946
12947 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12948 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12949 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12950 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12951 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12952 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12953 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12954 and cookies" below for more details.
12955
12956 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12957 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12958 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12959 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12960 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12961 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12962 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12963 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12964
12965
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200129668.2.4. Custom log format
12967------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012968
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012969The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012970mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012971
12972HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12973Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12974separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12975prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12976
12977Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12978variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12979string formats ("Q").
12980
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012981If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012982as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012983less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12984the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12985
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012986Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012987In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012988in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012989
12990Flags are :
12991 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012992 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012993
12994 Example:
12995
12996 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12997 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12998
12999At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13000
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013001 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13002 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013003
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013004the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013005
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013006 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013007 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013008 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013009
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013010and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13011
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013012 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013013 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13014
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013015Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13016
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013017 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013018 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013019 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13020 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13021 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013022 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13023 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13024 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013025 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013026 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013027 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013028 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013029 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013030 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013031 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13032 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013033 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013034 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13035 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013036 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013037 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13038 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013039 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13040 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13041 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013042 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013043 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13044 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013045 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013046 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13047 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13048 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013049 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013050 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013051 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13052 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13053 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13054 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013055 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013056 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013057 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013058 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013059 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013060 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013061 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13062 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13063 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013064 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013065 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13066 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013067 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013068 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013069 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013070 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013071
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013072 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013073
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013074
130758.2.5. Error log format
13076-----------------------
13077
13078When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13079protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13080By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13081"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13082will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13083logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13084
13085The format looks like this :
13086
13087 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13088 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13089 Connection error during SSL handshake
13090
13091 Field Format Extract from the example above
13092 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13093 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13094 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13095 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13096 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13097
13098These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13099failures.
13100
13101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131028.3. Advanced logging options
13103-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013104
13105Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13106just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13107options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13108for more information about their usage.
13109
13110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131118.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13112------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013113
13114It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13115haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13116commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13117monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13118ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13119
13120 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13121 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13122 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13123 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13124
13125 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13126 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13127 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013128 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013129 such as other load-balancers.
13130
13131 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13132 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13133 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13134
13135
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131368.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13137----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013138
13139The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13140what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13141or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13142"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13143just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13144log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13145after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13146is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13147with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13148with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13149
13150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131518.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13152------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013153
13154Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13155for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13156"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13157retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13158raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13159a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13160file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13161you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13162"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13163
13164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131658.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13166--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013167
13168Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13169multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13170them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13171"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13172logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13173error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13174and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
13175too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
13176useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
13177alternative.
13178
13179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131808.4. Timing events
13181------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013182
13183Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
13184reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
13185the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
13186frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
13187mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
13188
13189 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
13190 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
13191 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
13192 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
13193 the client closes prematurely or times out.
13194
13195 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
13196 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
13197 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
13198 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
13199 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
13200
13201 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
13202 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
13203 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
13204 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
13205 connection never established.
13206
13207 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
13208 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
13209 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
13210 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
13211 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
13212 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
13213 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
13214 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
13215 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
13216 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
13217 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
13218
13219 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
13220 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
13221 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
13222 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013223 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013224
13225 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
13226
13227 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
13228 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
13229 negative.
13230
13231These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13232protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13233that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013234due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013235close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13236session has been aborted on timeout.
13237
13238Most common cases :
13239
13240 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13241 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13242 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13243 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13244 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13245 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13246 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13247 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13248 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013249 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13250 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13251 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013252
13253 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13254 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13255 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13256 of ms on remote networks.
13257
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013258 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13259 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13260 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013261
13262 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13263 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13264 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13265 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13266 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13267 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13268 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13269 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13270 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13271 to the server until another one is released.
13272
13273Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13274
13275 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13276 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13277 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13278
13279 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13280 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13281 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13282
13283 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13284 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13285 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13286 flags.
13287
13288 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13289 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13290 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13291 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13292 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13293 the client connection was maintained open.
13294
13295 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013296 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013297 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13298 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13299
13300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133018.5. Session state at disconnection
13302-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013303
13304TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13305"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
133062-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13307each of which has a special meaning :
13308
13309 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13310 session to terminate :
13311
13312 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13313
13314 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13315 server explicitly refused it.
13316
13317 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13318 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13319 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13320 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013321 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13322
13323 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13324 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013325
13326 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13327 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13328 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13329 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13330 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13331
13332 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13333 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13334 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13335 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13336 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13337
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013338 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13339 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13340
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013341 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13342 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13343 backup connections when going up.
13344
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013345 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13346
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013347 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13348 send or receive data.
13349
13350 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13351 send or receive data.
13352
13353 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13354 with nothing left in the buffers.
13355
13356 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13357
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013358 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013359 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13360
13361 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13362 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13363 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13364 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13365 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13366
13367 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13368 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13369
13370 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13371 server (HTTP only).
13372
13373 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13374
13375 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13376 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13377 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13378
13379 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13380 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13381 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13382
13383 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13384
13385 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13386 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13387
13388 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13389 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13390 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13391
13392 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13393 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013394 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13395 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013396
13397 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13398 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13399 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13400 another server.
13401
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013402 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013403 server.
13404
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013405 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13406 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13407 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13408 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13409
13410 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13411 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13412 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13413 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13414
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013415 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13416 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13417 "use-server" rule).
13418
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013419 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13420
13421 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13422 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13423
13424 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13425
13426 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13427 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13428 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13429
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013430 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13431 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013432 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013433 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13434 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13435
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013436 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13437
13438 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13439 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13440
13441 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13442
13443 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13444
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013445The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13446was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013447helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13448starvation, attacks, etc...
13449
13450The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13451alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13452easier finding and understanding.
13453
13454 Flags Reason
13455
13456 -- Normal termination.
13457
13458 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13459 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13460 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13461 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13462
13463 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13464 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13465 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13466 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13467 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13468 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013469
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013470 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13471 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013472 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013473
13474 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13475 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13476 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13477
13478 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13479 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13480 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13481 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13482 the server takes too long to respond.
13483
13484 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13485 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13486 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13487 long a time to respond.
13488
13489 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13490 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13491 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13492 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
13493 and the client.
13494
13495 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13496 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13497 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13498 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13499 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013500 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
13501 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
13502 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
13503 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
13504 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
13505 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
13506 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
13507 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
13508 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
13509 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
13510 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
13511 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
13512 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
13513 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013514
13515 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13516 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013517 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13518 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13519 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13520 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013521
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013522 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13523 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13524
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013525 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013526 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13527 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13528 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13529 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13530 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13531
13532 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13533 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13534 503 or 504 here.
13535
13536 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13537 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13538 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13539 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13540 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13541
13542 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13543 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013544 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013545 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13546 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13547
13548 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13549 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13550 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13551 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13552 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13553 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13554 between haproxy and the server.
13555
13556 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13557 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13558 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13559 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13560 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13561 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13562 solution is to fix the application.
13563
13564 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13565 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13566 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13567 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13568 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13569 external attacks.
13570
13571 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13572 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013573 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013574 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13575 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13576
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013577 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13578 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13579 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013580 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13581 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013582
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013583 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13584 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13585 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13586 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013587 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13588 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13589 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13590 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13591 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013592
13593 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13594 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13595 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13596 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13597
13598 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13599 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13600 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13601 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13602
13603 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13604 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13605 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13606 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13607
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013608The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13609persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13610important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13611re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13612
13613 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13614
13615 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13616 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13617 set on a GET request.
13618
13619 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13620 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013621 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013622 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13623
13624 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13625 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13626 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13627
13628 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13629 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13630 already got a cookie.
13631
13632 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13633 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13634 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13635 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13636 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13637
13638 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13639 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13640 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13641
13642 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13643 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13644 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13645
13646 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13647 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13648
13649 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13650 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13651 then advertised in the response.
13652
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013653
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136548.6. Non-printable characters
13655-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013656
13657In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13658consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13659converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13660prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13661being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13662escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13663is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13664'}' when logging headers.
13665
13666Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13667issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13668containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13669
13670Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13671the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13672performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13673
13674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136758.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13676---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013677
13678Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13679achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013680section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013681cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13682the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13683the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013684locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013685not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13686user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13687a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13688wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13689
13690 Examples :
13691 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13692 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13693
13694 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13695 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13696
13697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136988.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13699---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013700
13701Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13702proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13703the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13704server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13705
13706Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13707response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013708section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013709
13710It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013711time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13712appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013713are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13714and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13715follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13716request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13717in the logs.
13718
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013719As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13720frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13721an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13722
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013723 Example :
13724 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13725 listen proxy-out
13726 mode http
13727 option httplog
13728 option logasap
13729 log global
13730 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13731
13732 # log the name of the virtual server
13733 capture request header Host len 20
13734
13735 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13736 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13737
13738 # log the beginning of the referrer
13739 capture request header Referer len 20
13740
13741 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13742 capture response header Server len 20
13743
13744 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13745 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13746
13747 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13748 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13749
13750 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13751 capture response header Via len 20
13752
13753 # log the URL location during a redirection
13754 capture response header Location len 20
13755
13756 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13757 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13758 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13759 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13760 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13761
13762 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13763 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13764 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13765 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013766 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013767
13768 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13769 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13770 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13771 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13772 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013773 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013774
13775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137768.9. Examples of logs
13777---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013778
13779These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13780them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13781reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13782
13783 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13784 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13785 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13786
13787 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13788 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13789
13790 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13791 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13792 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13793
13794 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13795 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13796
13797 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13798 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13799 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13800
13801 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013802 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013803 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13804 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13805
13806 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13807 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13808 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13809
13810 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13811 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013812 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013813 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13814 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13815 to return the 502 and not the server.
13816
13817 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013818 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013819
13820 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13821 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13822 Nothing was sent to any server.
13823
13824 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13825 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13826
13827 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13828 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13829 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13830 send a 408 return code to the client.
13831
13832 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13833 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13834
13835 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13836 5 seconds ("c----").
13837
13838 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13839 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013840 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013841
13842 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013843 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013844 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13845 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13846 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13847 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13848 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013849
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138519. Statistics and monitoring
13852----------------------------
13853
13854It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13855mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13856CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13857Unix socket.
13858
13859
138609.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013861---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013862
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013863The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013864page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13865begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13866represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13867use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13868('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13869(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13870text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13871do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13872use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013873
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013874In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13875that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13876S (Servers).
13877
13878 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13879 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13880 any name for server/listener)
13881 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13882 number queued without a server assigned.
13883 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13884 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13885 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13886 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13887 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13888 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13889 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13890 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13891 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13892 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13893 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13894 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13895 "option checkcache".
13896 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13897 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13898 - read error from the client
13899 - client timeout
13900 - client closed connection
13901 - various bad requests from the client.
13902 - request was tarpitted.
13903 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13904 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13905 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13906 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13907 active servers).
13908 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13909 Some other errors are:
13910 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13911 - failure applying filters to the response.
13912 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13913 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13914 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13915 switched away from.
13916 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13917 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13918 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13919 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13920 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13921 the server is up.)
13922 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13923 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13924 counters for each server.
13925 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13926 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13927 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13928 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13929 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13930 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13931 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13932 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13933 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13934 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13935 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13936 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13937 of times that server was selected.
13938 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13939 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13940 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13941 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13942 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13943 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013944 UNK -> unknown
13945 INI -> initializing
13946 SOCKERR -> socket error
13947 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13948 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13949 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13950 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13951 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13952 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13953 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13954 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13955 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13956 disable-on-404
13957 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13958 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13959 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013960 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13961 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13962 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13963 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13964 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13965 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13966 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13967 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13968 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13969 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13970 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13971 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13972 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13973 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13974 (inc. in eresp)
13975 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13976 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13977 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13978 (CPU/BW limit)
13979 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13980 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13981 server/backend
13982 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13983 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13984 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13985 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13986 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13987 (0 for TCP)
13988 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13989 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013990
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139929.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013993-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013994
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013995The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13996necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13997A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13998issuing commands by hand :
13999
14000 global
14001 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14002 stats timeout 2m
14003
14004It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14005the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14006never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14007situations :
14008
14009 global
14010 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14011 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14012 stats timeout 2m
14013
14014To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14015swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14016to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14017syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14018
14019 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14020 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14021
14022The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14023script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14024for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14025
14026The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14027that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14028editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14029(eg: watch a counter).
14030
14031The socket supports two operation modes :
14032 - interactive
14033 - non-interactive
14034
14035The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14036this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14037sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14038mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14039commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14040example :
14041
14042 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14043
14044The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14045entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14046for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14047sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14048"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14049after processing the last command of the same line.
14050
14051For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14052"prompt" command :
14053
14054 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14055 prompt
14056 > show info
14057 ...
14058 >
14059
14060Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14061delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14062that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14063parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014064
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014065It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14066on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14067own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014068
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014069The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14070If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14071all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14072it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14073
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014074add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014075 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14076 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14077 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14078 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014079
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014080add map <map> <key> <value>
14081 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14082 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014083 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14084 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14085 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014086
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014087clear counters
14088 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14089 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14090 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14091 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14092 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14093
14094clear counters all
14095 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14096 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14097 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14098
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014099clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014100 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14101 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14102 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014103
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014104clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014105 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14106 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14107 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014108
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014109clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14110 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14111
14112 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14113 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14114 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14115 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14116 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14117 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14118
14119 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14120
14121 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14122 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14123 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14124 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14125 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14126 the ACLs :
14127
14128 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14129 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14130 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14131 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14132 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14133 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14134
14135 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014136 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14137 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014138
14139 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014140 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014141 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014142 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14143 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14144 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14145 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014146
14147 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14148
14149 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014150 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014151 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14152 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014153 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14154 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14155 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014156
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014157del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14158 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014159 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14160 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14161 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14162 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014163
14164del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014165 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014166 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14167 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14168 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14169 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014170
14171disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014172 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14173
14174 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
14175 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
14176 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
14177 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
14178 re-enabled using enable agent.
14179
14180 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
14181 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
14182 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
14183 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
14184 otherwise unchanged.
14185
14186 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
14187 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
14188 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
14189
14190 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14191 level "admin".
14192
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014193disable frontend <frontend>
14194 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
14195 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
14196 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
14197 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
14198 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
14199 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
14200 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
14201 on the stats page.
14202
14203 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14204 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14205
14206 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14207 level "admin".
14208
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014209disable health <backend>/<server>
14210 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
14211 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
14212 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
14213 agent check forces it down.
14214
14215 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14216 level "admin".
14217
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014218disable server <backend>/<server>
14219 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
14220 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
14221 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
14222 during the maintenance.
14223
14224 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
14225 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
14226
14227 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014228 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014229
14230 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14231 level "admin".
14232
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014233enable agent <backend>/<server>
14234 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14235
14236 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14237 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14238
14239 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14240 level "admin".
14241
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014242enable frontend <frontend>
14243 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14244 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14245 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14246 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14247 which was disabled.
14248
14249 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14250 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14251
14252 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14253 level "admin".
14254
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014255enable health <backend>/<server>
14256 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14257 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14258
14259 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14260 level "admin".
14261
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014262enable server <backend>/<server>
14263 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14264 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14265
14266 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014267 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014268
14269 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14270 level "admin".
14271
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014272get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014273get acl <acl> <value>
14274 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14275 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14276 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14277 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14278 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014279
14280 The first two words are:
14281
14282 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14283 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14284 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14285
14286 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14287
14288 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14289
14290 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14291
14292 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14293 interpretation of the case.
14294
14295 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14296 useful with regular expressions.
14297
14298 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14299 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14300
14301 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14302 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14303 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14304
14305 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14306
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014307get weight <backend>/<server>
14308 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14309 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14310 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14311 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14312 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014313 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014314
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014315help
14316 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14317 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014318
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014319prompt
14320 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14321 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14322 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14323 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14324 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14325 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14326 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14327 command.
14328
14329quit
14330 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014331
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014332set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014333 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14334 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14335 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014336
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014337set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014338 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14339 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14340 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14341 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14342 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014343 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14344 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14345
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014346set maxconn global <maxconn>
14347 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14348 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14349 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14350 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14351 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14352 setting.
14353
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014354set rate-limit connections global <value>
14355 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14356 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14357 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14358 is passed in number of connections per second.
14359
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014360set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14361 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14362 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014363 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14364 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014365
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014366set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14367 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14368 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14369 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14370 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14371
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014372set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14373 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14374 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14375 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14376 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14377 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14378
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014379set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14380 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14381 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14382 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14383
14384set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14385 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14386 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14387 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14388
14389set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14390 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14391 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14392 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14393 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14394 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14395 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14396 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14397 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14398
14399set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14400 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14401 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14402
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014403set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14404 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14405 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14406 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14407 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14408
14409 Example:
14410 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14411 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14412 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14413 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14414
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014415set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014416 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14417 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14418 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14419 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014420 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14421 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014422
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014423set timeout cli <delay>
14424 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14425 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14426 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14427
14428set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14429 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14430 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014431 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14432 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14433 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14434 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14435 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14436 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14437 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14438 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14439 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14440 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14441 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14442 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14443 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014444
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014445show errors [<iid>]
14446 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14447 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014448 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14449 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14450 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014451
14452 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14453 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14454 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14455 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14456 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14457 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14458 are reported too.
14459
14460 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14461 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14462 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14463 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14464 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14465 code.
14466
14467 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14468 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14469 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14470 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14471 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14472 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14473 line.
14474
14475 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014476 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14477 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014478 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14479 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14480
14481 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14482 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14483 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14484 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14485 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14486 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14487 00204+ minal\r\n
14488 00211 \r\n
14489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014490 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014491 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14492 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14493 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14494 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14495 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14496 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014497
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014498show info
14499 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14500
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014501show map [<map>]
14502 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014503 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14504 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14505 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14506 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14507 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14508 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014509
14510show acl [<acl>]
14511 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014512 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14513 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14514 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14515 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14516 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014517
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014518show pools
14519 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14520 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14521 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14522 the pools.
14523
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014524show sess
14525 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014526 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14527 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14528
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014529show sess <id>
14530 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14531 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14532 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14533 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14534 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014535 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14536 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14537
14538 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14539 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014540
14541show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14542 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14543 possible to dump only selected items :
14544 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14545 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14546 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14547 for example:
14548 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14549 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14550 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14551
14552 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014553 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14554 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014555 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14556 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14557 Nbproc: 1
14558 Process_num: 1
14559 (...)
14560
14561 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14562 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14563 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14564 (...)
14565 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14566
14567 $
14568
14569 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14570 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14571 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14572 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014573 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014574
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014575show table
14576 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14577 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14578 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14579 entries currently in use.
14580
14581 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014582 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014583 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14584 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014585
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014586show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014587 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14588 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14589 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014590 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14591
14592 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14593 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14594 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14595 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14596 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14597
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014598 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14599 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14600 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14601 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14602 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14603 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14604
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014605
14606 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014607 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14608 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014609
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014610 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014611 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014612 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014613 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14614 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14615 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14616 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014617
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014618 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014619 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014620 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14621 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014622
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014623 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14624 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014625 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014626 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14627 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014628
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014629 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14630 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014631 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014632 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14633 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14634
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014635 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14636 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14637 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14638 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14639 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14640
14641 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14642 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14643 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014644 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14645 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014646 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14647 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014648
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014649shutdown frontend <frontend>
14650 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14651 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14652 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14653 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14654 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14655 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14656 once it is terminated.
14657
14658 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14659 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14660
14661 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14662 level "admin".
14663
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014664shutdown session <id>
14665 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14666 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14667 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14668 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14669 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14670 flag in the logs.
14671
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014672shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014673 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14674 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14675 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14676 'K' flag in the logs.
14677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014678/*
14679 * Local variables:
14680 * fill-column: 79
14681 * End:
14682 */